* elf32-ppc.c: Formatting.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
21c294e6 149* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
6d2ebf8b
SS
150* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
151* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 152* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
153
154* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
155* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
156
157* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
158* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
159* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 160* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 161* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
162* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 164* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
165* Index:: Index
166@end menu
167
6c0e9fb3 168@end ifnottex
c906108c 169
449f3b6c 170@contents
449f3b6c 171
6d2ebf8b 172@node Summary
c906108c
SS
173@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182@itemize @bullet
183@item
184Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186@item
187Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189@item
190Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192@item
193Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195@end itemize
196
cce74817 197You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 198For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
199For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
cce74817 201@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
202Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 204
cce74817
JM
205@cindex Pascal
206Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209syntax.
c906108c 210
c906108c
SS
211@cindex Fortran
212@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 213it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 214underscore.
c906108c 215
c906108c
SS
216@menu
217* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
218* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
219@end menu
220
6d2ebf8b 221@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
222@unnumberedsec Free software
223
5d161b24 224@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
225General Public License
226(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
227program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
228freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
229the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
230Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
231Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
232
233Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
234you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
235from anyone else.
236
2666264b 237@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
238
239The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
240the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
241include with the free software. Many of our most important
242programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
243texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
244when an important free software package does not come with a free
245manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
246gaps today.
247
248Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
249normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
250authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
251copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
252them from the free software world.
253
254That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
255from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
256manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
257only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
258contract to make it non-free.
259
260Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
261price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
262charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
263Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
264problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
265are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
266modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
267
268The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
269free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
270commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
271accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
272
273Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
274When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
275are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
276provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
277manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
278a changed version of the program is not really available to our
279community.
280
281Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
282acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
283author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
284authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
285to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
286may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
287with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
288are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
289of the manual.
290
291However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
292content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
293media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
294obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
295manual to replace it.
296
297Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
298lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
299free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
300the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
301realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
302the free software community.
303
304If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
305the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
306license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
307don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
308will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
309option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
310what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
311try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 312is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
313
314You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
315manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
316copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
317improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
318at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
319and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
320Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
321have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
322
323The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
324published by other publishers, at
325@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
326
6d2ebf8b 327@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
328@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
329
330Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
331other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
332development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
333of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
334to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
335file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
336blow-by-blow account.
337
338Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
339
340@quotation
341@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
342or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
343omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
344@end quotation
345
346So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
347particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
348releases:
299ffc64 349Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
350Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
351Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
352Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
353Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
354Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
355John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
356Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
357and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
358
359Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
360Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
361
b37052ae
EZ
362Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
363in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
364Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
365demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
366much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 367
b37052ae 368@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
369object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
370Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
371
372David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
373the original support for encapsulated COFF.
374
0179ffac 375Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
c906108c
SS
376
377Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
378Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
379support.
380Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
381Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
382Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
383David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
384Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
385Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
386Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
387Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
388Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
389Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
390Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
391Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
392Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
393Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
394Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 395Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 396
1104b9e7 397Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
398
399Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
400libraries.
401
402Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
403about several machine instruction sets.
404
405Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
406remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
407contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
408and RDI targets, respectively.
409
410Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
411command-line editing and command history.
412
7a292a7a
SS
413Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
414Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 415
5d161b24 416Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 417He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 418symbols.
c906108c
SS
419
420Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
421Super-H processors.
422
423NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
424
425Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
426
427Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
428
429Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
430
96a2c332 431Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
432
433Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
434watchpoints.
435
436Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
437
438Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
439
440Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 441nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
442
443The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
444support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 445(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
446compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
447John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
448Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
449information in this manual.
450
b37052ae
EZ
451DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
452Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
453
96a2c332
SS
454Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
455development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
456fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
457Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
458Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
459Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
460Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
461addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
462JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
463Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
464Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
465Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
466Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
467Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
468Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 469
e2e0bcd1
JB
470Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
471Hat.
c906108c 472
6d2ebf8b 473@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
474@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
475
476You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
477However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
478debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
479
480@iftex
481In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
482to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
483@end iftex
484
485@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
486@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
487
488One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
489processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
490quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
491definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
492session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
493then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
494same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
495@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
496procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
497
498@smallexample
499$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
500$ @b{./m4}
501@b{define(foo,0000)}
502
503@b{foo}
5040000
505@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
506
507@b{bar}
5080000
509@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
510
511@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
512@b{baz}
513@b{C-d}
514m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
515@end smallexample
516
517@noindent
518Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
519
c906108c
SS
520@smallexample
521$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
522@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
523@c FIXME... format to come out better.
524@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 525 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 526 the conditions.
5d161b24 527There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
528 for details.
529
530@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
531(@value{GDBP})
532@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
533
534@noindent
535@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
536rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
537We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
538that examples fit in this manual.
539
540@smallexample
541(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
542@end smallexample
543
544@noindent
545We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
546Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
547@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
548@code{break} command.
549
550@smallexample
551(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
552Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
553@end smallexample
554
555@noindent
556Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
557control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
558subroutine, the program runs as usual:
559
560@smallexample
561(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
562Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
563@b{define(foo,0000)}
564
565@b{foo}
5660000
567@end smallexample
568
569@noindent
570To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
571suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
572context where it stops.
573
574@smallexample
575@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
576
5d161b24 577Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
578 at builtin.c:879
579879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
580@end smallexample
581
582@noindent
583Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
584the next line of the current function.
585
586@smallexample
587(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
589 : nil,
590@end smallexample
591
592@noindent
593@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
594by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
595@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
596subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
597
598@smallexample
599(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
600set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
601 at input.c:530
602530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
603@end smallexample
604
605@noindent
606The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
607suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
608shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
609command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
610in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
611stack frame for each active subroutine.
612
613@smallexample
614(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
615#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
616 at input.c:530
5d161b24 617#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
618 at builtin.c:882
619#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
620#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
621 at macro.c:71
622#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
623#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
628times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
629falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6330x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6350x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
636def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
639 : xstrdup(rq);
640(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
641538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
642@end smallexample
643
644@noindent
645The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
646@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
647and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
648(@code{print}) to see their values.
649
650@smallexample
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
652$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
653(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
654$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
655@end smallexample
656
657@noindent
658@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
659To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
660surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
661
662@smallexample
663(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
664533 xfree(rquote);
665534
666535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
667 : xstrdup (lq);
668536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
669 : xstrdup (rq);
670537
671538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
672539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
673540 @}
674541
675542 void
676@end smallexample
677
678@noindent
679Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
680@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
681
682@smallexample
683(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
686540 @}
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
688$3 = 9
689(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
690$4 = 7
691@end smallexample
692
693@noindent
694That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
695@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
696@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
697the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
698any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
699assignments.
700
701@smallexample
702(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
703$5 = 7
704(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
705$6 = 9
706@end smallexample
707
708@noindent
709Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
710@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
711executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
712example that caused trouble initially:
713
714@smallexample
715(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
716Continuing.
717
718@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
719
720baz
7210000
722@end smallexample
723
724@noindent
725Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
726problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
727lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
728
729@smallexample
730@b{C-d}
731Program exited normally.
732@end smallexample
733
734@noindent
735The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
736indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
737session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
738
739@smallexample
740(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
741@end smallexample
c906108c 742
6d2ebf8b 743@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
744@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
745
746This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 747The essentials are:
c906108c 748@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 749@item
53a5351d 750type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 751@item
c906108c
SS
752type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
753@end itemize
754
755@menu
756* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
757* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
758* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
759@end menu
760
6d2ebf8b 761@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
762@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
763
c906108c
SS
764Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
765@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
766
767You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
768to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
769
c906108c
SS
770The command-line options described here are designed
771to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 772options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
773
774The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
775specifying an executable program:
776
474c8240 777@smallexample
c906108c 778@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 779@end smallexample
c906108c 780
c906108c
SS
781@noindent
782You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
783specified:
784
474c8240 785@smallexample
c906108c 786@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 787@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
788
789You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
790to debug a running process:
791
474c8240 792@smallexample
c906108c 793@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 794@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
795
796@noindent
797would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
798named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
799
c906108c 800Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
801complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
802debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
803``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
804will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 805
aa26fa3a
TT
806You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
807executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
808option processing.
474c8240 809@smallexample
aa26fa3a 810gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 811@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
812This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
813@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
814
96a2c332 815You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
816@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
817
818@smallexample
819@value{GDBP} -silent
820@end smallexample
821
822@noindent
823You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
824options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
825
826@noindent
827Type
828
474c8240 829@smallexample
c906108c 830@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 831@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
832
833@noindent
834to display all available options and briefly describe their use
835(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
836
837All options and command line arguments you give are processed
838in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
839@samp{-x} option is used.
840
841
842@menu
c906108c
SS
843* File Options:: Choosing files
844* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
845@end menu
846
6d2ebf8b 847@node File Options
c906108c
SS
848@subsection Choosing files
849
2df3850c 850When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
851specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
852the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
853@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
854first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
855equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
856second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
857equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
858If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
859first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
860to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
861a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 862prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
863
864If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
865such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
866argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
867
868Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
869following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
870them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
871(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
872than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
873
d700128c
EZ
874@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
875@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
876@c it.
877
c906108c
SS
878@table @code
879@item -symbols @var{file}
880@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
881@cindex @code{--symbols}
882@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
883Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
884
885@item -exec @var{file}
886@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
887@cindex @code{--exec}
888@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
889Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
890and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
891
892@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 893@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
894Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
895file.
896
c906108c
SS
897@item -core @var{file}
898@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
899@cindex @code{--core}
900@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 901Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
902
903@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
904@item -pid @var{number}
905@itemx -p @var{number}
906@cindex @code{--pid}
907@cindex @code{-p}
908Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
909If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
910file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
911
912@item -command @var{file}
913@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
914@cindex @code{--command}
915@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
916Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
917Files,, Command files}.
918
919@item -directory @var{directory}
920@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
921@cindex @code{--directory}
922@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
923Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
924
c906108c
SS
925@item -m
926@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
927@cindex @code{--mapped}
928@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
929@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
930supported on all systems.}@*
931If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 932system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
933to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
934program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 935called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
936Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
937and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
938the symbol table from the executable program.
939
940The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
941is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
942table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 943
c906108c
SS
944@item -r
945@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
946@cindex @code{--readnow}
947@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
948Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
949the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
950This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 951
c906108c
SS
952@end table
953
2df3850c 954You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 955order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
956information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
957on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
958but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 959
474c8240 960@smallexample
2df3850c 961gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 962@end smallexample
c906108c 963
6d2ebf8b 964@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
965@subsection Choosing modes
966
967You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
968batch mode or quiet mode.
969
970@table @code
971@item -nx
972@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
973@cindex @code{--nx}
974@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 975Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
976@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
977options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
978files}.
c906108c
SS
979
980@item -quiet
d700128c 981@itemx -silent
c906108c 982@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
983@cindex @code{--quiet}
984@cindex @code{--silent}
985@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
986``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
987messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
988
989@item -batch
d700128c 990@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
991Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
992command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
993initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
994nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
995in the command files.
996
2df3850c
JM
997Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
998example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
999make this more useful, the message
c906108c 1000
474c8240 1001@smallexample
c906108c 1002Program exited normally.
474c8240 1003@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1004
1005@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1006(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1007@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1008mode.
1009
1010@item -nowindows
1011@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1012@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1013@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1014``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1015(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1016interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1017
1018@item -windows
1019@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1020@cindex @code{--windows}
1021@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1022If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1023used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1024
1025@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1026@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1027Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1028instead of the current directory.
1029
c906108c
SS
1030@item -fullname
1031@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1032@cindex @code{--fullname}
1033@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1034@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1035subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1036number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1037displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1038recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1039the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1040and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1041@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1042frame.
c906108c 1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -epoch
1045@cindex @code{--epoch}
1046The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1047@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1048routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1049separate window.
1050
1051@item -annotate @var{level}
1052@cindex @code{--annotate}
1053This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1054effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1055(@pxref{Annotations}).
1056Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1057together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1058types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1059@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1060maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1061
1062@item -async
1063@cindex @code{--async}
1064Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1065@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1066special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1067commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1068run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1069MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1070suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1071control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1072(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1073operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1074yet.)
1075@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1076@c should be removed.
1077
1078When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1079uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1080@samp{-noasync} option.
1081
1082@item -noasync
1083@cindex @code{--noasync}
1084Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1085
aa26fa3a
TT
1086@item --args
1087@cindex @code{--args}
1088Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1089executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1090This option stops option processing.
1091
2df3850c
JM
1092@item -baud @var{bps}
1093@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1094@cindex @code{--baud}
1095@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1096Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1097interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1098
1099@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1100@itemx -t @var{device}
1101@cindex @code{--tty}
1102@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1103Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1104@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1105
53a5351d 1106@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1107@item -tui
1108@cindex @code{--tui}
1109Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1110The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1111showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1112(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1113Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1114(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1115
1116@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1117@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1118@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1119@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1120@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1121@c systems.
1122
d700128c
EZ
1123@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1124@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1125Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1126program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0 1127communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
21c294e6 1128@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
94bbb2c0 1129
da0f9dcd
AC
1130@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1131@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1132(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1133interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1134@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1135are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1136
1137@item -write
1138@cindex @code{--write}
1139Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1140is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1141(@pxref{Patching}).
1142
1143@item -statistics
1144@cindex @code{--statistics}
1145This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1146memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1147
1148@item -version
1149@cindex @code{--version}
1150This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1151no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1152
c906108c
SS
1153@end table
1154
6d2ebf8b 1155@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1156@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1157@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1158@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1159
1160@table @code
1161@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1162@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1163@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1164@itemx q
1165To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1166@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1167do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1168otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1169error code.
c906108c
SS
1170@end table
1171
1172@cindex interrupt
1173An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1174terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1175returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1176character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1177until a time when it is safe.
1178
c906108c
SS
1179If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1180device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1181(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1182
6d2ebf8b 1183@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1184@section Shell commands
1185
1186If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1187debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1188just use the @code{shell} command.
1189
1190@table @code
1191@kindex shell
1192@cindex shell escape
1193@item shell @var{command string}
1194Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1195If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1196shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1197(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1198@end table
1199
1200The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1201You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1202@value{GDBN}:
1203
1204@table @code
1205@kindex make
1206@cindex calling make
1207@item make @var{make-args}
1208Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1209arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1210@end table
1211
6d2ebf8b 1212@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1213@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1214
1215You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1216name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1217@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1218key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1219show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1220
1221@menu
1222* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1223* Completion:: Command completion
1224* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1225@end menu
1226
6d2ebf8b 1227@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1228@section Command syntax
1229
1230A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1231how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1232arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1233command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1234step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1235with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1236
1237@cindex abbreviation
1238@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1239unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1240documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1241abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1242equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1243names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1244arguments to the @code{help} command.
1245
1246@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1247@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1248A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1249repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1250will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1251repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1252repeat.
1253
1254The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1255@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1256exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1257
1258@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1259output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1260(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1261@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1262repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1263
41afff9a 1264@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1265@cindex comment
1266Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1267nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1268Files,,Command files}).
1269
88118b3a
TT
1270@cindex repeating command sequences
1271@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1272The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1273commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1274then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1275for editing.
1276
6d2ebf8b 1277@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1278@section Command completion
1279
1280@cindex completion
1281@cindex word completion
1282@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1283only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1284are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1285commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1286
1287Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1288of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1289word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1290enter it). For example, if you type
1291
1292@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1293@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1294@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1295@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1296@smallexample
c906108c 1297(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1298@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1299
1300@noindent
1301@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1302the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1303
474c8240 1304@smallexample
c906108c 1305(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1306@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1307
1308@noindent
1309You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1310breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1311@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1312were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1313might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1314to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1315
1316If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1317@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1318characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1319@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1320example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1321begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1322just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1323function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1324example:
1325
474c8240 1326@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1327(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1328@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1329make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1330make_abs_section make_function_type
1331make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1332make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1333make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1334(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1335@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1336
1337@noindent
1338After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1339partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1340command.
1341
1342If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1343can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1344means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1345key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1346one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1347
1348@cindex quotes in commands
1349@cindex completion of quoted strings
1350Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1351parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1352its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1353situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1354@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1355
c906108c 1356The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1357name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1358overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1359by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1360may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1361that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1362that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1363word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1364@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1365@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1366when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1367
474c8240 1368@smallexample
96a2c332 1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1370bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1371(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1372@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1373
1374In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1375quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1376completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1377place:
1378
474c8240 1379@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1380(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1381@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1382(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1383@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1384
1385@noindent
1386In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1387you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1388completion on an overloaded symbol.
1389
d4f3574e 1390For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1391expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1392overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1393see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1394
1395
6d2ebf8b 1396@node Help
c906108c
SS
1397@section Getting help
1398@cindex online documentation
1399@kindex help
1400
5d161b24 1401You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1402using the command @code{help}.
1403
1404@table @code
41afff9a 1405@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1406@item help
1407@itemx h
1408You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1409display a short list of named classes of commands:
1410
1411@smallexample
1412(@value{GDBP}) help
1413List of classes of commands:
1414
2df3850c 1415aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1416breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1417data -- Examining data
c906108c 1418files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1419internals -- Maintenance commands
1420obscure -- Obscure features
1421running -- Running the program
1422stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1423status -- Status inquiries
1424support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1425tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1426 stopping the program
c906108c 1427user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1428
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1430commands in that class.
5d161b24 1431Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1432documentation.
1433Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1434(@value{GDBP})
1435@end smallexample
96a2c332 1436@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1437
1438@item help @var{class}
1439Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1440list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1441help display for the class @code{status}:
1442
1443@smallexample
1444(@value{GDBP}) help status
1445Status inquiries.
1446
1447List of commands:
1448
1449@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1450@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1451info -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the program being debugged
1453show -- Generic command for showing things
1454 about the debugger
c906108c 1455
5d161b24 1456Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1457documentation.
1458Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1459(@value{GDBP})
1460@end smallexample
1461
1462@item help @var{command}
1463With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1464short paragraph on how to use that command.
1465
6837a0a2
DB
1466@kindex apropos
1467@item apropos @var{args}
1468The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1469commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1470@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1471
1472@smallexample
1473apropos reload
1474@end smallexample
1475
b37052ae
EZ
1476@noindent
1477results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1478
1479@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1480@c @group
1481set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1484 multiple times in one run
1485@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1486@end smallexample
1487
c906108c
SS
1488@kindex complete
1489@item complete @var{args}
1490The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1491for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1492command you want completed. For example:
1493
1494@smallexample
1495complete i
1496@end smallexample
1497
1498@noindent results in:
1499
1500@smallexample
1501@group
2df3850c
JM
1502if
1503ignore
c906108c
SS
1504info
1505inspect
c906108c
SS
1506@end group
1507@end smallexample
1508
1509@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1510@end table
1511
1512In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1513and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1514of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1515manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1516under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1517all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1518
1519@c @group
1520@table @code
1521@kindex info
41afff9a 1522@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1523@item info
1524This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1525program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1526with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1527registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1528You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1529@w{@code{help info}}.
1530
1531@kindex set
1532@item set
5d161b24 1533You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1534@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1535@code{set prompt $}.
1536
1537@kindex show
1538@item show
5d161b24 1539In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1540@value{GDBN} itself.
1541You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1542related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1543system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1544which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1545
1546@kindex info set
1547To display all the settable parameters and their current
1548values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1549@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1550@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1551@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1552@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1553@end table
1554@c @end group
1555
1556Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1557exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1558
1559@table @code
1560@kindex show version
1561@cindex version number
1562@item show version
1563Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1564information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1565@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1566version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1567commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1568system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1569variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1570The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1571@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1572
1573@kindex show copying
1574@item show copying
1575Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1576
1577@kindex show warranty
1578@item show warranty
2df3850c 1579Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1580if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1581
c906108c
SS
1582@end table
1583
6d2ebf8b 1584@node Running
c906108c
SS
1585@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1586
1587When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1588debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1589
1590You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1591of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1592your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1593kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1594
1595@menu
1596* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1597* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1598* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1599* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1600
1601* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1602* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1603* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1604* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1605
1606* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1607* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1608@end menu
1609
6d2ebf8b 1610@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1611@section Compiling for debugging
1612
1613In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1614debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1615is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1616variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1617and addresses in the executable code.
1618
1619To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1620the compiler.
1621
e2e0bcd1
JB
1622Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1623the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1624because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1625the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1626options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1627debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1628``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1629to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1630@option{-g} alone.
1631
c906108c
SS
1632Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1633options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1634executables containing debugging information.
1635
53a5351d
JM
1636@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1637without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1638recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1639program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1640in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1641
1642@cindex optimized code, debugging
1643@cindex debugging optimized code
1644When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1645optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1646really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1647exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1648variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1649variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1650
1651Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1652@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1653doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1654please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1655
1656Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1657@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1658format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1659
1660@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1661@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1662@section Starting your program
1663@cindex starting
1664@cindex running
1665
1666@table @code
1667@kindex run
41afff9a 1668@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1669@item run
1670@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1671Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1672You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1673argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1674@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1675(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1676
1677@end table
1678
c906108c
SS
1679If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1680supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1681that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1682@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1683
1684The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1685receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1686information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1687can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1688your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1689divided into four categories:
1690
1691@table @asis
1692@item The @emph{arguments.}
1693Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1694@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1695is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1696(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1697the arguments.
1698In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1699@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1700@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1701
1702@item The @emph{environment.}
1703Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1704use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1705environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1706your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1707
1708@item The @emph{working directory.}
1709Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1710the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1711@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1712
1713@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1714Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1715standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1716in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1717set a different device for your program.
1718@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1719
1720@cindex pipes
1721@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1722pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1723program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1724wrong program.
1725@end table
c906108c
SS
1726
1727When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1728immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1729of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1730stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1731or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1732
1733If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1734time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1735table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1736your current breakpoints.
1737
6d2ebf8b 1738@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1739@section Your program's arguments
1740
1741@cindex arguments (to your program)
1742The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1743@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1744They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1745performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1746@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1747@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1748the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1749
1750On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1751@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1752calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1753the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1754
1755@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1756@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1757
c906108c 1758@table @code
41afff9a 1759@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1760@item set args
1761Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1762@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1763with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1764using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1765it again without arguments.
1766
1767@kindex show args
1768@item show args
1769Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1770@end table
1771
6d2ebf8b 1772@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1773@section Your program's environment
1774
1775@cindex environment (of your program)
1776The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1777their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1778your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1779path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1780the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1781debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1782environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1783
1784@table @code
1785@kindex path
1786@item path @var{directory}
1787Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1788(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1789The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1790You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1791system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1792MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1793is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1794
1795You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1796working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1797use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1798@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1799@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1800@var{directory} to the search path.
1801@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1802@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1803
1804@kindex show paths
1805@item show paths
1806Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1807environment variable).
1808
1809@kindex show environment
1810@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1811Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1812your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1813print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1814your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1815
1816@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1817@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1818Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1819changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1820be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1821any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1822parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1823null value.
1824@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1825@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1826
1827For example, this command:
1828
474c8240 1829@smallexample
c906108c 1830set env USER = foo
474c8240 1831@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1832
1833@noindent
d4f3574e 1834tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1835@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1836are not actually required.)
1837
1838@kindex unset environment
1839@item unset environment @var{varname}
1840Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1841program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1842@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1843rather than assigning it an empty value.
1844@end table
1845
d4f3574e
SS
1846@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1847the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1848by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1849@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1850that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1851@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1852your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1853files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1854@file{.profile}.
1855
6d2ebf8b 1856@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1857@section Your program's working directory
1858
1859@cindex working directory (of your program)
1860Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1861working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1862The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1863from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1864working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1865
1866The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1867that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1868specify files}.
1869
1870@table @code
1871@kindex cd
1872@item cd @var{directory}
1873Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1874
1875@kindex pwd
1876@item pwd
1877Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1878@end table
1879
6d2ebf8b 1880@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1881@section Your program's input and output
1882
1883@cindex redirection
1884@cindex i/o
1885@cindex terminal
1886By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1887the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1888to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1889modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1890running your program.
1891
1892@table @code
1893@kindex info terminal
1894@item info terminal
1895Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1896program is using.
1897@end table
1898
1899You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1900redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1901
474c8240 1902@smallexample
c906108c 1903run > outfile
474c8240 1904@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1905
1906@noindent
1907starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1908
1909@kindex tty
1910@cindex controlling terminal
1911Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1912with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1913argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1914commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1915process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1916
474c8240 1917@smallexample
c906108c 1918tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1919@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1920
1921@noindent
1922directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1923default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1924that as their controlling terminal.
1925
1926An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1927effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1928terminal.
1929
1930When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1931command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1932for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1933
6d2ebf8b 1934@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1935@section Debugging an already-running process
1936@kindex attach
1937@cindex attach
1938
1939@table @code
1940@item attach @var{process-id}
1941This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1942outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1943targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1944find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1945or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1946
1947@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1948executing the command.
1949@end table
1950
1951To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1952which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1953programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1954also have permission to send the process a signal.
1955
1956When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1957the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1958the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1959(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1960the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1961Specify Files}.
1962
1963The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1964process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1965with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1966you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1967can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1968process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1969attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1970
1971@table @code
1972@kindex detach
1973@item detach
1974When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1975@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1976the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1977that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1978are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1979@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1980executing the command.
1981@end table
1982
1983If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1984attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1985for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1986control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1987confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1988messages}).
1989
6d2ebf8b 1990@node Kill Process
c906108c 1991@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@table @code
1994@kindex kill
1995@item kill
1996Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1997@end table
1998
1999This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2000running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2001is running.
2002
2003On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2004while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2005@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2006outside the debugger.
2007
2008The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2009relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2010executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2011next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2012reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2013breakpoint settings).
2014
6d2ebf8b 2015@node Threads
c906108c 2016@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2017
2018@cindex threads of execution
2019@cindex multiple threads
2020@cindex switching threads
2021In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2022may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2023of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2024the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2025that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2026modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2027registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2028
2029@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2030programs:
2031
2032@itemize @bullet
2033@item automatic notification of new threads
2034@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2035@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2036@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2037a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2038@item thread-specific breakpoints
2039@end itemize
2040
c906108c
SS
2041@quotation
2042@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2043@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2044If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2045effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2046from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2047like this:
2048
2049@smallexample
2050(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2051(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2052Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2053see the IDs of currently known threads.
2054@end smallexample
2055@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2056@c doesn't support threads"?
2057@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2058
2059@cindex focus of debugging
2060@cindex current thread
2061The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2062threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2063control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2064This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2065program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2066
41afff9a 2067@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2068@cindex thread identifier (system)
2069@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2070@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2071@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2072Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2073the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2074form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2075whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2076LynxOS, you might see
2077
474c8240 2078@smallexample
c906108c 2079[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2080@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2081
2082@noindent
2083when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2084the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2085further qualifier.
2086
2087@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2088@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2089@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2090@c program?
2091@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2092@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2093@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2094
2095@cindex thread number
2096@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2097For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2098number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2099
2100@table @code
2101@kindex info threads
2102@item info threads
2103Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2104program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2105
2106@enumerate
2107@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2108
2109@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2110
2111@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2112@end enumerate
2113
2114@noindent
2115An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2116indicates the current thread.
2117
5d161b24 2118For example,
c906108c
SS
2119@end table
2120@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2121
2122@smallexample
2123(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2124 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2125 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2126* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2127 at threadtest.c:68
2128@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2129
2130On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2131
2132@cindex thread number
2133@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2134For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2135number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2136thread in your program.
2137
41afff9a
EZ
2138@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2139@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2140@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2141@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2142@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2143Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2144both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2145form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2146whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2147HP-UX, you see
2148
474c8240 2149@smallexample
c906108c 2150[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2151@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2152
2153@noindent
5d161b24 2154when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2155
2156@table @code
2157@kindex info threads
2158@item info threads
2159Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2160program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2161
2162@enumerate
2163@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2164
2165@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2166
2167@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2168@end enumerate
2169
2170@noindent
2171An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2172indicates the current thread.
2173
5d161b24 2174For example,
c906108c
SS
2175@end table
2176@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2177
474c8240 2178@smallexample
c906108c 2179(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2180 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2181 at quicksort.c:137
2182 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2184 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2185 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2186@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2187
2188@table @code
2189@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2190@item thread @var{threadno}
2191Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2192argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2193shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2194@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2195you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2196
2197@smallexample
2198@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2199(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2200[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
22010x34e5 in sigpause ()
2202@end smallexample
2203
2204@noindent
2205As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2206@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2207threads.
c906108c
SS
2208
2209@kindex thread apply
2210@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2211The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2212more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2213with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2214@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2215threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2216@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2217@end table
2218
2219@cindex automatic thread selection
2220@cindex switching threads automatically
2221@cindex threads, automatic switching
2222Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2223signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2224signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2225message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2226thread.
2227
2228@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2229more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2230programs with multiple threads.
2231
2232@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2233watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2234
6d2ebf8b 2235@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2236@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2237
2238@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2239@cindex multiple processes
2240@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2241On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2242programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2243function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2244parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2245set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2246will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2247will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2248
2249However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2250which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2251the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2252only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2253so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2254on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2255get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2256@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2257the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2258the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2259
53a5351d
JM
2260On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2261debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2262@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2263
2264By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2265the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2266
2267If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2268use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2269
2270@table @code
2271@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2272@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2273Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2274@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2275process. The @var{mode} can be:
2276
2277@table @code
2278@item parent
2279The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2280unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2281
2282@item child
2283The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2284unimpeded.
2285
2286@item ask
2287The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2288@end table
2289
2290@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2291Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2292@end table
2293
2294If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2295@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2296breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2297@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2298the child process's @code{main}.
2299
2300When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2301child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2302
2303If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2304call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2305use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2306argument.
2307
2308You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2309a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2310Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2311
6d2ebf8b 2312@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2313@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2314
2315The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2316program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2317trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2318
7a292a7a
SS
2319Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2320such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2321@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2322change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2323continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2324ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2325explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2326
2327@table @code
2328@kindex info program
2329@item info program
2330Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2331running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2332@end table
2333
2334@menu
2335* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2336* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2337* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2338* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2339@end menu
2340
6d2ebf8b 2341@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2342@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2343
2344@cindex breakpoints
2345A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2346the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2347control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2348breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2349Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2350should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2351program.
2352
2353In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2354breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2355a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2356is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2357not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2358arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2359
2360@cindex watchpoints
2361@cindex memory tracing
2362@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2363@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2364A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2365when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2366command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2367watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2368any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2369and watchpoints using the same commands.
2370
2371You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2372whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2373Automatic display}.
2374
2375@cindex catchpoints
2376@cindex breakpoint on events
2377A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2378when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2379exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2380different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2381catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2382other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2383@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2384
2385@cindex breakpoint numbers
2386@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2387@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2388catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2389starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2390features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2391breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2392@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2393enable it again.
2394
c5394b80
JM
2395@cindex breakpoint ranges
2396@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2397Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2398operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2399@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2400hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2401all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2402
c906108c
SS
2403@menu
2404* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2405* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2406* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2407* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2408* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2409* Conditions:: Break conditions
2410* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2411* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2412* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2413@end menu
2414
6d2ebf8b 2415@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2416@subsection Setting breakpoints
2417
5d161b24 2418@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2419@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2420@c
2421@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2422
2423@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2424@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2425@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2426@cindex latest breakpoint
2427Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2428@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2429number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2430Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2431convenience variables.
2432
2433You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2434
2435@table @code
2436@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2437Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2438When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2439C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2440@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2441
2442@item break +@var{offset}
2443@itemx break -@var{offset}
2444Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2445at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2446(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@item break @var{linenum}
2449Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2450The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2451The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2452code on that line.
2453
2454@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2455Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2456
2457@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2458Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2459@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2460superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2461functions.
2462
2463@item break *@var{address}
2464Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2465breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2466information or source files.
2467
2468@item break
2469When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2470the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2471(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2472innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2473returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2474@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2475that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2476@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2477the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2478inside loops.
2479
2480@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2481least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2482would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2483breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2484existed when your program stopped.
2485
2486@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2487Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2488@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2489value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2490@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2491above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2492,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2493
2494@kindex tbreak
2495@item tbreak @var{args}
2496Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2497same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2498way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2499program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2500
c906108c
SS
2501@kindex hbreak
2502@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2503Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2504@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2505breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2506have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2507debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2508changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2509provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2510will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2511address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2512breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2513example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2514@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2515or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2516(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2517
2518@kindex thbreak
2519@item thbreak @var{args}
2520Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2521are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2522the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2523the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2524first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2525command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2526may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2527See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2528
2529@kindex rbreak
2530@cindex regular expression
2531@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2532Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2533@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2534matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2535breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2536the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2537them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2538
2539The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2540like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2541shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2542an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2543@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2544match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2545
b37052ae 2546When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2547breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2548classes.
c906108c
SS
2549
2550@kindex info breakpoints
2551@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2552@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2554@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2555Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2556not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2557
2558@table @emph
2559@item Breakpoint Numbers
2560@item Type
2561Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2562@item Disposition
2563Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2564@item Enabled or Disabled
2565Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2566that are not enabled.
2567@item Address
2df3850c 2568Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2569@item What
2570Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2571line number.
2572@end table
2573
2574@noindent
2575If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2576the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2577are listed after that.
2578
2579@noindent
2580@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2581number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2582convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2583the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2584listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2585
2586@noindent
2587@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2588has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2589@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2590hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2591was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2592will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2593@end table
2594
2595@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2596your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2597the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2598(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2599
2600@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2601@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2602@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2603special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2604programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2605starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2606You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2607@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2608
2609
6d2ebf8b 2610@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2611@subsection Setting watchpoints
2612
2613@cindex setting watchpoints
2614@cindex software watchpoints
2615@cindex hardware watchpoints
2616You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2617expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2618this may happen.
2619
2620Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2621hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2622program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2623times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2624catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2625culprit.)
2626
1104b9e7 2627On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2628@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2629hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2630program.
2631
2632@table @code
2633@kindex watch
2634@item watch @var{expr}
2635Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2636is written into by the program and its value changes.
2637
2638@kindex rwatch
2639@item rwatch @var{expr}
2640Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2641
2642@kindex awatch
2643@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2644Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2645by the program.
c906108c
SS
2646
2647@kindex info watchpoints
2648@item info watchpoints
2649This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2650it is the same as @code{info break}.
2651@end table
2652
2653@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2654watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2655value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2656cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2657executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2658statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2659
2660When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2661
474c8240 2662@smallexample
c906108c 2663Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2664@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2665
2666@noindent
2667if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2668
7be570e7
JM
2669Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2670hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2671value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2672every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2673that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2674hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2675will print a message like this:
2676
2677@smallexample
2678Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2679@end smallexample
2680
2681Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2682data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2683watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2684can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2685cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2686double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2687wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2688into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2689
2690If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2691to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2692Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2693time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2694able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2695warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2696
2697@smallexample
2698Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2699@end smallexample
2700
2701@noindent
2702If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2703
2704The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2705or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2706data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2707hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2708both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2709watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2710@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2711watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2712@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2713Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2714
2715If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2716any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2717kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2718
7be570e7
JM
2719@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2720(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2721they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2722which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2723being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2724and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2725rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2726way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2727@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2728
c906108c
SS
2729@quotation
2730@cindex watchpoints and threads
2731@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2732@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2733usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2734can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2735you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2736thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2737can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2738@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2739the expression.
53a5351d 2740
d4f3574e 2741@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2742@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2743have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2744watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2745single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2746change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2747confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2748software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2749when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2750watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2751@end quotation
c906108c 2752
6d2ebf8b 2753@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2754@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2755@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2756@cindex exception handlers
2757@cindex event handling
2758
2759You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2760kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2761shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2762
2763@table @code
2764@kindex catch
2765@item catch @var{event}
2766Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2767@table @code
2768@item throw
2769@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2770The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2771
2772@item catch
2773@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2774The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2775
2776@item exec
2777@kindex catch exec
2778A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2779
2780@item fork
2781@kindex catch fork
2782A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2783
2784@item vfork
2785@kindex catch vfork
2786A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2787
2788@item load
2789@itemx load @var{libname}
2790@kindex catch load
2791The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2792@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2793
2794@item unload
2795@itemx unload @var{libname}
2796@kindex catch unload
2797The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2798of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2799@end table
2800
2801@item tcatch @var{event}
2802Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2803automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2804
2805@end table
2806
2807Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2808
b37052ae 2809There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2810(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2811
2812@itemize @bullet
2813@item
2814If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2815control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2816raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2817returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2818simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2819that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2820you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2821disabled within interactive calls.
2822
2823@item
2824You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2825
2826@item
2827You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2828@end itemize
2829
2830@cindex raise exceptions
2831Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2832if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2833stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2834can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2835breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2836out where the exception was raised.
2837
2838To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2839knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2840raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2841which has the following ANSI C interface:
2842
474c8240 2843@smallexample
c906108c 2844 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2845 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2846 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2847@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2848
2849@noindent
2850To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2851unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2852(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2853
2854With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2855that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2856a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2857breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2858raised.
2859
2860
6d2ebf8b 2861@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2862@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2863
2864@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2865@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2866It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2867catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2868to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2869breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2870
2871With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2872where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2873delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2874their breakpoint numbers.
2875
2876It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2877automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2878when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2879
2880@table @code
2881@kindex clear
2882@item clear
2883Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2884selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2885the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2886breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2887
2888@item clear @var{function}
2889@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2890Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2891
2892@item clear @var{linenum}
2893@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2894Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2895
2896@cindex delete breakpoints
2897@kindex delete
41afff9a 2898@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2899@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2900Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2901ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2902breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2903confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2904@end table
2905
6d2ebf8b 2906@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2907@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2908
2909@kindex disable breakpoints
2910@kindex enable breakpoints
2911Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2912prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2913it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2914that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2915
2916You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2917the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2918or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2919@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2920catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2921
2922A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2923states of enablement:
2924
2925@itemize @bullet
2926@item
2927Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2928with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2929@item
2930Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2931@item
2932Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2933disabled.
c906108c
SS
2934@item
2935Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2936immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2937set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2938@end itemize
2939
2940You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2941watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2942
2943@table @code
2944@kindex disable breakpoints
2945@kindex disable
41afff9a 2946@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2947@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2948Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2949listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2950options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2951case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2952@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2953
2954@kindex enable breakpoints
2955@kindex enable
c5394b80 2956@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2957Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2958become effective once again in stopping your program.
2959
c5394b80 2960@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2961Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2962of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2963
c5394b80 2964@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2965Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2966deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2967@end table
2968
d4f3574e
SS
2969@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2970@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2971Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2972,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2973subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2974the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2975breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2976breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2977stepping}.)
2978
6d2ebf8b 2979@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2980@subsection Break conditions
2981@cindex conditional breakpoints
2982@cindex breakpoint conditions
2983
2984@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2985@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2986The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2987specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2988breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2989programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2990a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2991and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2992
2993This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2994situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2995when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2996by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2997@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2998
2999Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3000since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3001it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3002and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3003one.
3004
3005Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3006your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3007that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3008format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3009unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3010that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3011program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3012breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3013conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3014purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3015(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3016
3017Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3018@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3019Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3020with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3021
c906108c
SS
3022You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3023The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3024@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3025catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3026
3027@table @code
3028@kindex condition
3029@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3030Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3031watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3032breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3033@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3034@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3035syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3036referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3037symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3038prints an error message:
3039
474c8240 3040@smallexample
d4f3574e 3041No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3042@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3043
3044@noindent
c906108c
SS
3045@value{GDBN} does
3046not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3047command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3048@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3049
3050@item condition @var{bnum}
3051Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3052an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3053@end table
3054
3055@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3056A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3057breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3058useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3059count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3060is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3061therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3062ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3063the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3064value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3065your program reaches it.
3066
3067@table @code
3068@kindex ignore
3069@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3070Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3071The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3072execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3073takes no action.
3074
3075To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3076a count of zero.
3077
3078When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3079breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3080@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3081Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3082
3083If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3084condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3085@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3086
3087You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3088as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3089is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3090variables}.
3091@end table
3092
3093Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3094
3095
6d2ebf8b 3096@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3097@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3098
3099@cindex breakpoint commands
3100You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3101commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3102example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3103enable other breakpoints.
3104
3105@table @code
3106@kindex commands
3107@kindex end
3108@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3109@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3110@itemx end
3111Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3112themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3113@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3114
3115To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3116follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3117
3118With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3119breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3120recently encountered).
3121@end table
3122
3123Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3124disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3125
3126You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3127use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3128that resumes execution.
3129
3130Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3131execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3132(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3133another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3134ambiguities about which list to execute.
3135
3136@kindex silent
3137If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3138usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3139be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3140then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3141see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3142meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3143
3144The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3145print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3146breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3147
3148For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3149value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3150
474c8240 3151@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3152break foo if x>0
3153commands
3154silent
3155printf "x is %d\n",x
3156cont
3157end
474c8240 3158@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3159
3160One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3161you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3162of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3163erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3164to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3165so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3166command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3167
474c8240 3168@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3169break 403
3170commands
3171silent
3172set x = y + 4
3173cont
3174end
474c8240 3175@end smallexample
c906108c 3176
6d2ebf8b 3177@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3178@subsection Breakpoint menus
3179@cindex overloading
3180@cindex symbol overloading
3181
b37052ae 3182Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3183to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3184This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3185@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3186a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3187something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3188particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3189you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3190waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3191options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3192sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3193@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3194breakpoints.
3195
3196For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3197breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3198We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3199
3200@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3201@smallexample
3202@group
3203(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3204[0] cancel
3205[1] all
3206[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3207[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3208[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3209[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3210[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3211[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3212> 2 4 6
3213Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3214Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3215Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3216Multiple breakpoints were set.
3217Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3218 breakpoints.
3219(@value{GDBP})
3220@end group
3221@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3222
3223@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3224@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3225@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3226@c
3227@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3228@c
d4f3574e
SS
3229Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3230any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3231attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3232@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3233
474c8240 3234@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3235Cannot insert breakpoints.
3236The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3237@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3238
3239When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3240
3241@enumerate
3242@item
3243Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3244
3245@item
5d161b24 3246Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3247name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3248that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3249Then start your program again.
3250
3251@item
3252Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3253linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3254to nonsharable executables.
3255@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3256@c @end ifclear
3257
d4f3574e
SS
3258A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3259hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3260
3261@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3262@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3263@smallexample
3264Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3265You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3266@end smallexample
3267
3268@noindent
3269This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3270only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3271watchpoints it needs to insert.
3272
3273When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3274hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3275
3276
6d2ebf8b 3277@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3278@section Continuing and stepping
3279
3280@cindex stepping
3281@cindex continuing
3282@cindex resuming execution
3283@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3284completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3285one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3286line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3287particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3288your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3289it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3290@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3291
3292@table @code
3293@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3294@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3295@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3296@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3298@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3299Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3300any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3301@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3302ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3303@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3304
3305The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3306stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3307@code{continue} is ignored.
3308
d4f3574e
SS
3309The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3310debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3311purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3312@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3313@end table
3314
3315To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3316(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3317calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3318different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3319
3320A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3321(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3322beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3323is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3324and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3325interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3326
3327@table @code
3328@kindex step
41afff9a 3329@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3330@item step
3331Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3332line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3333abbreviated @code{s}.
3334
3335@quotation
3336@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3337@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3338@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3339@c distinction here.
3340@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3341within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3342execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3343debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3344is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3345without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3346below.
3347@end quotation
3348
4a92d011
EZ
3349The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3350line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3351@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3352to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3353the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3354called within the line.
c906108c 3355
d4f3574e
SS
3356Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3357number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3358@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3359on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3360was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3361
3362@item step @var{count}
3363Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3364breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3365@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3366
3367@kindex next
41afff9a 3368@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3369@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3370Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3371This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3372the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3373control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3374that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3375is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3376
3377An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3378
3379
3380@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3381@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3382@c
3383@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3384@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3385@c function are executed without stopping.
3386
d4f3574e
SS
3387The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3388source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3389@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3390
b90a5f51
CF
3391@kindex set step-mode
3392@item set step-mode
3393@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3394@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3395@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3396The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3397stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3398information rather than stepping over it.
3399
4a92d011
EZ
3400This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3401machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3402want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3403
3404@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3405Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3406debug information. This is the default.
3407
c906108c
SS
3408@kindex finish
3409@item finish
3410Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3411returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3412
3413Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3414,Returning from a function}).
3415
3416@kindex until
41afff9a 3417@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3418@item until
3419@itemx u
3420Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3421current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3422stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3423command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3424automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3425than the address of the jump.
3426
3427This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3428though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3429exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3430simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3431through the next iteration.
3432
3433@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3434stack frame.
3435
3436@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3437of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3438example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3439(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3440@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3441
474c8240 3442@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3443(@value{GDBP}) f
3444#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3445206 expand_input();
3446(@value{GDBP}) until
3447195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3448@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3449
3450This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3451generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3452start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3453written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3454to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3455expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3456statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3457
3458@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3459instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3460argument.
3461
3462@item until @var{location}
3463@itemx u @var{location}
3464Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3465reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3466the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3467,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3468hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3469location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3470implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3471invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3472line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3473line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3474invocations have returned.
3475
3476@smallexample
347794 int factorial (int value)
347895 @{
347996 if (value > 1) @{
348097 value *= factorial (value - 1);
348198 @}
348299 return (value);
3483100 @}
3484@end smallexample
3485
3486
3487@kindex advance @var{location}
3488@itemx advance @var{location}
3489Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3490required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3491command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3492frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3493not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3494have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3495
c906108c
SS
3496
3497@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3498@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3499@item stepi
96a2c332 3500@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3501@itemx si
3502Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3503
3504It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3505instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3506instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3507Display,, Automatic display}.
3508
3509An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3510
3511@need 750
3512@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3513@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3514@item nexti
96a2c332 3515@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3516@itemx ni
3517Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3518proceed until the function returns.
3519
3520An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3521@end table
3522
6d2ebf8b 3523@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3524@section Signals
3525@cindex signals
3526
3527A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3528operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3529kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3530signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3531@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3532memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3533the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3534requested an alarm).
3535
3536@cindex fatal signals
3537Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3538functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3539errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3540program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3541@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3542fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3543
3544@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3545program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3546signal.
3547
3548@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3549Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3550@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3551(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3552but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3553You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3554
3555@table @code
3556@kindex info signals
3557@item info signals
96a2c332 3558@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3559Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3560handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3561the defined types of signals.
3562
d4f3574e 3563@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3564
3565@kindex handle
3566@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3567Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3568can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3569@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3570@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3571known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3572@end table
3573
3574@c @group
3575The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3576Their full names are:
3577
3578@table @code
3579@item nostop
3580@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3581still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3582
3583@item stop
3584@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3585the @code{print} keyword as well.
3586
3587@item print
3588@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3589
3590@item noprint
3591@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3592implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3593
3594@item pass
5ece1a18 3595@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3596@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3597can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3598and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3599
3600@item nopass
5ece1a18 3601@itemx ignore
c906108c 3602@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3603@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3604@end table
3605@c @end group
3606
d4f3574e
SS
3607When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3608program until you
c906108c
SS
3609continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3610effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3611after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3612command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3613program sees that signal when you continue.
3614
24f93129
EZ
3615The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3616non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3617@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3618erroneous signals.
3619
c906108c
SS
3620You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3621seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3622or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3623due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3624values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3625execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3626a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3627you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3628program a signal}.
c906108c 3629
6d2ebf8b 3630@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3631@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3632
3633When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3634programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3635breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3636
3637@table @code
3638@cindex breakpoints and threads
3639@cindex thread breakpoints
3640@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3641@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3642@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3643@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3644writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3645
3646Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3647to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3648particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3649numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3650column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3651
3652If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3653breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3654program.
3655
3656You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3657well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3658breakpoint condition, like this:
3659
3660@smallexample
2df3850c 3661(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3662@end smallexample
3663
3664@end table
3665
3666@cindex stopped threads
3667@cindex threads, stopped
3668Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3669@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3670allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3671switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3672underfoot.
3673
3674@cindex continuing threads
3675@cindex threads, continuing
3676Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3677executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3678like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3679
3680In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3681Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3682system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3683execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3684single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3685statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3686stops.
3687
3688You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3689continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3690thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3691first thread completes whatever you requested.
3692
3693On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3694thread to run.
3695
3696@table @code
3697@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3698Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3699locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3700current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3701mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3702``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3703stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3704when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3705function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3706like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3707thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3708@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3709
3710@item show scheduler-locking
3711Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3712@end table
3713
c906108c 3714
6d2ebf8b 3715@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3716@chapter Examining the Stack
3717
3718When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3719stopped and how it got there.
3720
3721@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3722Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3723is generated.
3724That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3725the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3726and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3727The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3728The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3729stack}.
3730
3731When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3732stack allow you to see all of this information.
3733
3734@cindex selected frame
3735One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3736@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3737particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3738your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3739special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3740interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3741
3742When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3743currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3744@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3745
3746@menu
3747* Frames:: Stack frames
3748* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3749* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3750* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3751
3752@end menu
3753
6d2ebf8b 3754@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3755@section Stack frames
3756
d4f3574e 3757@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3758@cindex stack frame
3759The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3760frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3761with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3762to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3763which the function is executing.
3764
3765@cindex initial frame
3766@cindex outermost frame
3767@cindex innermost frame
3768When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3769function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3770@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3771made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3772is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3773the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3774actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3775recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3776
3777@cindex frame pointer
3778Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3779stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3780kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3781address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3782in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3783going on in that frame.
3784
3785@cindex frame number
3786@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3787zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3788and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3789they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3790frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3791
6d2ebf8b
SS
3792@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3793@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3794@cindex frameless execution
3795Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3796without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3797@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3798@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3799@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3800generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3801This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3802the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3803with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3804has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3805it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3806correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3807no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3808
3809@table @code
d4f3574e 3810@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3811@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3812@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3813The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3814and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3815address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3816@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3817
3818@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3819@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3820@item select-frame
3821The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3822to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3823@code{frame}.
3824@end table
3825
6d2ebf8b 3826@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3827@section Backtraces
3828
3829@cindex backtraces
3830@cindex tracebacks
3831@cindex stack traces
3832A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3833line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3834frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3835stack.
3836
3837@table @code
3838@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3839@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3840@item backtrace
3841@itemx bt
3842Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3843frames in the stack.
3844
3845You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3846character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3847
3848@item backtrace @var{n}
3849@itemx bt @var{n}
3850Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3851
3852@item backtrace -@var{n}
3853@itemx bt -@var{n}
3854Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3855@end table
3856
3857@kindex where
3858@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3859@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3860The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3861are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3862
3863Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3864The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3865print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3866line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3867counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3868line number.
3869
3870Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3871@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3872
3873@smallexample
3874@group
5d161b24 3875#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3876 at builtin.c:993
3877#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3878#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3879 at macro.c:71
3880(More stack frames follow...)
3881@end group
3882@end smallexample
3883
3884@noindent
3885The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3886value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3887code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3888
b4e9345d
DJ
3889@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3890@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3891
95f90d25
DJ
3892Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3893and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3894When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3895the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3896uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3897change this behavior.
3898
3899@table @code
3900@item set backtrace-below-main off
3901Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3902default.
3903
3904@item set backtrace-below-main
3905@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3906Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3907
3908@item show backtrace-below-main
3909Display the current backtrace policy.
3910@end table
3911
6d2ebf8b 3912@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3913@section Selecting a frame
3914
3915Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3916whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3917selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3918of the stack frame just selected.
3919
3920@table @code
d4f3574e 3921@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3922@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3923@item frame @var{n}
3924@itemx f @var{n}
3925Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3926(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3927innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3928@code{main}.
3929
3930@item frame @var{addr}
3931@itemx f @var{addr}
3932Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3933chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3934impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3935addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3936switches between them.
3937
c906108c
SS
3938On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3939select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3940
3941On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3942pointer and a program counter.
3943
3944On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3945pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3946@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3947@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3948@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3949
3950@kindex up
3951@item up @var{n}
3952Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3953advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3954that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3955
3956@kindex down
41afff9a 3957@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3958@item down @var{n}
3959Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3960advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3961that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3962abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3963@end table
3964
3965All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3966frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3967arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3968frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3969
3970@need 1000
3971For example:
3972
3973@smallexample
3974@group
3975(@value{GDBP}) up
3976#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3977 at env.c:10
397810 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3979@end group
3980@end smallexample
3981
3982After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3983prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3984You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3985editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3986@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3987for details.
c906108c
SS
3988
3989@table @code
3990@kindex down-silently
3991@kindex up-silently
3992@item up-silently @var{n}
3993@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3994These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3995respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3996causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3997in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3998distracting.
3999@end table
4000
6d2ebf8b 4001@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4002@section Information about a frame
4003
4004There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4005stack frame.
4006
4007@table @code
4008@item frame
4009@itemx f
4010When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4011frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4012selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4013argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4014@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4015
4016@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4017@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4018@item info frame
4019@itemx info f
4020This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4021including:
4022
4023@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4024@item
4025the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4026@item
4027the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4028@item
4029the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4030@item
4031the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4032@item
4033the address of the frame's arguments
4034@item
d4f3574e
SS
4035the address of the frame's local variables
4036@item
c906108c
SS
4037the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4038@item
4039which registers were saved in the frame
4040@end itemize
4041
4042@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4043something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4044the usual conventions.
4045
4046@item info frame @var{addr}
4047@itemx info f @var{addr}
4048Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4049selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4050command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4051architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4052@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4053
4054@kindex info args
4055@item info args
4056Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4057
4058@item info locals
4059@kindex info locals
4060Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4061line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4062accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4063
c906108c 4064@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4065@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4066@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4067@item info catch
4068Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4069current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4070exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4071@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4072@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4073
c906108c
SS
4074@end table
4075
c906108c 4076
6d2ebf8b 4077@node Source
c906108c
SS
4078@chapter Examining Source Files
4079
4080@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4081information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4082used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4083the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4084(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4085execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4086source files by explicit command.
4087
7a292a7a 4088If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4089prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4090@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4091
4092@menu
4093* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4094* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4095* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4096* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4097* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4098@end menu
4099
6d2ebf8b 4100@node List
c906108c
SS
4101@section Printing source lines
4102
4103@kindex list
41afff9a 4104@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4105To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4106(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4107There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4108
4109Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4110
4111@table @code
4112@item list @var{linenum}
4113Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4114current source file.
4115
4116@item list @var{function}
4117Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4118@var{function}.
4119
4120@item list
4121Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4122@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4123printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4124as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4125Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4126
4127@item list -
4128Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4129@end table
4130
4131By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4132the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4133
4134@table @code
4135@kindex set listsize
4136@item set listsize @var{count}
4137Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4138the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4139
4140@kindex show listsize
4141@item show listsize
4142Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4143@end table
4144
4145Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4146so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4147than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4148argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4149each repetition moves up in the source file.
4150
4151@cindex linespec
4152In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4153@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4154of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4155Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4156
4157@table @code
4158@item list @var{linespec}
4159Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4160
4161@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4162Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4163linespecs.
4164
4165@item list ,@var{last}
4166Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4167
4168@item list @var{first},
4169Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4170
4171@item list +
4172Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4173
4174@item list -
4175Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4176
4177@item list
4178As described in the preceding table.
4179@end table
4180
4181Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4182kinds of linespec.
4183
4184@table @code
4185@item @var{number}
4186Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4187When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4188the same source file as the first linespec.
4189
4190@item +@var{offset}
4191Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4192When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4193two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4194first linespec.
4195
4196@item -@var{offset}
4197Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4198
4199@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4200Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4201
4202@item @var{function}
4203Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4204For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4205
4206@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4207Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4208function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4209file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4210identically named functions in different source files.
4211
4212@item *@var{address}
4213Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4214@var{address} may be any expression.
4215@end table
4216
87885426
FN
4217@node Edit
4218@section Editing source files
4219@cindex editing source files
4220
4221@kindex edit
4222@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4223To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4224The editing program of your choice
4225is invoked with the current line set to
4226the active line in the program.
4227Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4228want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4229
4230Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4231
4232@table @code
4233@item edit
4234Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4235
4236@item edit @var{number}
4237Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4238
4239@item edit @var{function}
4240Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4241
4242@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4243Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4244
4245@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4246Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4247function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4248file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4249identically named functions in different source files.
4250
4251@item edit *@var{address}
4252Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4253@var{address} may be any expression.
4254@end table
4255
4256@subsection Choosing your editor
4257You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4258@footnote{
4259The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4260following command-line syntax:
10998722 4261@smallexample
87885426 4262ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4263@end smallexample
4264The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4265the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4266by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4267@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4268@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4269@smallexample
87885426
FN
4270EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4271export EDITOR
4272gdb ...
10998722 4273@end smallexample
87885426 4274or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4275@smallexample
87885426
FN
4276setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4277gdb ...
10998722 4278@end smallexample
87885426 4279
6d2ebf8b 4280@node Search
c906108c
SS
4281@section Searching source files
4282@cindex searching
4283@kindex reverse-search
4284
4285There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4286regular expression.
4287
4288@table @code
4289@kindex search
4290@kindex forward-search
4291@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4292@itemx search @var{regexp}
4293The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4294starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4295@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4296synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4297@code{fo}.
4298
4299@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4300The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4301with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4302for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4303this command as @code{rev}.
4304@end table
c906108c 4305
6d2ebf8b 4306@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4307@section Specifying source directories
4308
4309@cindex source path
4310@cindex directories for source files
4311Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4312files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4313the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4314session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4315this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4316it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4317in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4318the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4319the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4320path.
4321
4322If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4323object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4324too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4325compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4326last resort.
4327
4328Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4329any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4330each line is in the file.
4331
4332@kindex directory
4333@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4334When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4335and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4336To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4337
4338@table @code
4339@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4340@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4341Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4342directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4343(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4344part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4345whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4346path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4347
4348@kindex cdir
4349@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4350@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4351@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4352@cindex compilation directory
4353@cindex current directory
4354@cindex working directory
4355@cindex directory, current
4356@cindex directory, compilation
4357You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4358directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4359working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4360tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4361session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4362directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4363
4364@item directory
4365Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4366
4367@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4368@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4369
4370@item show directories
4371@kindex show directories
4372Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4373@end table
4374
4375If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4376interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4377versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4378
4379@enumerate
4380@item
4381Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4382
4383@item
4384Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4385directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4386directories in one command.
4387@end enumerate
4388
6d2ebf8b 4389@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4390@section Source and machine code
4391
4392You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4393addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4394a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4395mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4396line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4397well as hex.
4398
4399@table @code
4400@kindex info line
4401@item info line @var{linespec}
4402Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4403source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4404the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4405source lines}).
4406@end table
4407
4408For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4409the object code for the first line of function
4410@code{m4_changequote}:
4411
d4f3574e
SS
4412@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4413@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4414@smallexample
96a2c332 4415(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4416Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4417@end smallexample
4418
4419@noindent
4420We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4421@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4422@smallexample
4423(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4424Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4425@end smallexample
4426
4427@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4428@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4429After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4430is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4431sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4432,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4433convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4434variables}).
4435
4436@table @code
4437@kindex disassemble
4438@cindex assembly instructions
4439@cindex instructions, assembly
4440@cindex machine instructions
4441@cindex listing machine instructions
4442@item disassemble
4443This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4444instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4445program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4446command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4447surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4448(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4449@end table
4450
c906108c
SS
4451The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4452HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4453
4454@smallexample
4455(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4456Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44570x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44580x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44590x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44600x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44610x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44620x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44630x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44640x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4465End of assembler dump.
4466@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4467
4468Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4469mnemonics or other syntax.
4470
4471@table @code
d4f3574e 4472@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4473@cindex assembly instructions
4474@cindex instructions, assembly
4475@cindex machine instructions
4476@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4477@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4478@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4479@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4480Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4481program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4482
4483Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4484can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4485The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4486assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4487@end table
4488
4489
6d2ebf8b 4490@node Data
c906108c
SS
4491@chapter Examining Data
4492
4493@cindex printing data
4494@cindex examining data
4495@kindex print
4496@kindex inspect
4497@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4498@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4499@c different window or something like that.
4500The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4501command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4502evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4503program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4504Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4505
4506@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4507@item print @var{expr}
4508@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4509@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4510value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4511you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4512@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4513formats}.
4514
4515@item print
4516@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4517If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4518@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4519conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4520@end table
4521
4522A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4523It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4524specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4525
7a292a7a 4526If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4527fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4528command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4529Table}.
c906108c
SS
4530
4531@menu
4532* Expressions:: Expressions
4533* Variables:: Program variables
4534* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4535* Output Formats:: Output formats
4536* Memory:: Examining memory
4537* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4538* Print Settings:: Print settings
4539* Value History:: Value history
4540* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4541* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4542* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4543* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4544* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4545* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4546* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4547 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4548@end menu
4549
6d2ebf8b 4550@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4551@section Expressions
4552
4553@cindex expressions
4554@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4555compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4556by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4557@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4558casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4559you compiled your program to include this information; see
4560@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4561
d4f3574e
SS
4562@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4563the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4564you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4565memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4566
c906108c
SS
4567Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4568this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4569Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4570languages.
4571
4572In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4573expressions regardless of your programming language.
4574
4575Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4576useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4577at that address in memory.
4578@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4579
4580@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4581to programming languages:
4582
4583@table @code
4584@item @@
4585@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4586@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4587
4588@item ::
4589@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4590function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4591
4592@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4593@cindex type casting memory
4594@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4595@cindex casts, to view memory
4596@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4597Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4598memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4599pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4600a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4601normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4602@end table
4603
6d2ebf8b 4604@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4605@section Program variables
4606
4607The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4608in your program.
4609
4610Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4611(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4612
4613@itemize @bullet
4614@item
4615global (or file-static)
4616@end itemize
4617
5d161b24 4618@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4619
4620@itemize @bullet
4621@item
4622visible according to the scope rules of the
4623programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4624@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4625
4626@noindent This means that in the function
4627
474c8240 4628@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4629foo (a)
4630 int a;
4631@{
4632 bar (a);
4633 @{
4634 int b = test ();
4635 bar (b);
4636 @}
4637@}
474c8240 4638@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4639
4640@noindent
4641you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4642executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4643examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4644the block where @code{b} is declared.
4645
4646@cindex variable name conflict
4647There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4648scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4649in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4650function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4651happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4652you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4653using the colon-colon notation:
4654
d4f3574e 4655@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4656@iftex
4657@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4658@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4659@end iftex
474c8240 4660@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4661@var{file}::@var{variable}
4662@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4663@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4664
4665@noindent
4666Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4667static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4668make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4669to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4670
474c8240 4671@smallexample
c906108c 4672(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4673@end smallexample
c906108c 4674
b37052ae 4675@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4676This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4677use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4678scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4679@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4680@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4681
4682@cindex wrong values
4683@cindex variable values, wrong
4684@quotation
4685@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4686wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4687scope, and just before exit.
4688@end quotation
4689You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4690This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4691set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4692stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4693values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4694also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4695after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4696variable definitions may be gone.
4697
4698This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4699To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4700when compiling.
4701
d4f3574e
SS
4702@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4703Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4704unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4705opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4706offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4707might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4708happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4709
474c8240 4710@smallexample
d4f3574e 4711No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4712@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4713
4714To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4715different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
0179ffac
DC
4716formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4717usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4718produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4719COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4720an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4721for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
d4f3574e
SS
4722
4723
6d2ebf8b 4724@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4725@section Artificial arrays
4726
4727@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4728@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4729It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4730same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4731dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4732program.
4733
4734You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4735@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4736operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4737and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4738of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4739the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4740argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4741following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4742example. If a program says
4743
474c8240 4744@smallexample
c906108c 4745int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4746@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4747
4748@noindent
4749you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4750
474c8240 4751@smallexample
c906108c 4752p *array@@len
474c8240 4753@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4754
4755The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4756with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4757subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4758Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4759(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4760
4761Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4762This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4763The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4764@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4765(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4766$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4767@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4768
4769As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4770@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4771the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4772@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4773(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4774$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4775@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4776
4777Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4778moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4779actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4780of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4781to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4782variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4783interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4784instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4785structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4786in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4787
474c8240 4788@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4789set $i = 0
4790p dtab[$i++]->fv
4791@key{RET}
4792@key{RET}
4793@dots{}
474c8240 4794@end smallexample
c906108c 4795
6d2ebf8b 4796@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4797@section Output formats
4798
4799@cindex formatted output
4800@cindex output formats
4801By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4802this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4803in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4804at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4805these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4806
4807The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4808already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4809@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4810letters supported are:
4811
4812@table @code
4813@item x
4814Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4815hexadecimal.
4816
4817@item d
4818Print as integer in signed decimal.
4819
4820@item u
4821Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4822
4823@item o
4824Print as integer in octal.
4825
4826@item t
4827Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4828@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4829used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4830see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4831
4832@item a
4833@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4834@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4835Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4836the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4837where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4838
474c8240 4839@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4840(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4841$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4842@end smallexample
c906108c 4843
3d67e040
EZ
4844@noindent
4845The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4846@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4847
c906108c
SS
4848@item c
4849Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4850
4851@item f
4852Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4853using typical floating point syntax.
4854@end table
4855
4856For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4857
474c8240 4858@smallexample
c906108c 4859p/x $pc
474c8240 4860@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4861
4862@noindent
4863Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4864names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4865
4866To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4867you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4868expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4869
6d2ebf8b 4870@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4871@section Examining memory
4872
4873You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4874any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4875
4876@cindex examining memory
4877@table @code
41afff9a 4878@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4879@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4880@itemx x @var{addr}
4881@itemx x
4882Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4883@end table
4884
4885@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4886much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4887expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4888If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4889Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4890
4891@table @r
4892@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4893The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4894how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4895@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4896@c 4.1.2.
4897
4898@item @var{f}, the display format
4899The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4900@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4901The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4902The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4903
4904@item @var{u}, the unit size
4905The unit size is any of
4906
4907@table @code
4908@item b
4909Bytes.
4910@item h
4911Halfwords (two bytes).
4912@item w
4913Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4914@item g
4915Giant words (eight bytes).
4916@end table
4917
4918Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4919default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4920@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4921
4922@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4923@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4924memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4925it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4926@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4927@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4928other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4929the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4930starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4931a value from memory).
4932@end table
4933
4934For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4935(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4936starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4937words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4938@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4939
4940Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4941letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4942unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4943specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4944(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4945
4946Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4947and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4948@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4949including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4950alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4951Code,,Source and machine code}.
4952
4953All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4954easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4955you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4956instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4957with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4958the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4959for successive uses of @code{x}.
4960
4961@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4962The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4963in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4964would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4965subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4966@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4967examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4968@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4969the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4970
4971If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4972are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4973address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4974
6d2ebf8b 4975@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4976@section Automatic display
4977@cindex automatic display
4978@cindex display of expressions
4979
4980If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4981(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4982display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4983Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4984to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4985The automatic display looks like this:
4986
474c8240 4987@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49882: foo = 38
49893: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4990@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4991
4992@noindent
4993This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4994displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4995specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4996whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4997format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4998or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4999supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5000
5001@table @code
5002@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5003@item display @var{expr}
5004Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5005each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5006
5007@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5008
d4f3574e 5009@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5010For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5011count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5012arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5013@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5014
5015@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5016For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5017number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5018be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5019doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5020@end table
5021
5022For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5023instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5024is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5025
5026@table @code
5027@kindex delete display
5028@kindex undisplay
5029@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5030@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5031Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5032
5033@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5034(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5035
5036@kindex disable display
5037@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5038Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5039item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5040enabled again later.
5041
5042@kindex enable display
5043@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5044Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5045again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5046
5047@item display
5048Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5049done when your program stops.
5050
5051@kindex info display
5052@item info display
5053Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5054automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5055values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5056It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5057because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5058@end table
5059
5060If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5061sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5062expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5063variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5064@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5065@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5066continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5067there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5068automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5069is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5070
6d2ebf8b 5071@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5072@section Print settings
5073
5074@cindex format options
5075@cindex print settings
5076@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5077and symbols are printed.
5078
5079@noindent
5080These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5081
5082@table @code
5083@kindex set print address
5084@item set print address
5085@itemx set print address on
5086@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5087traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5088even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5089is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5090@code{set print address on}:
5091
5092@smallexample
5093@group
5094(@value{GDBP}) f
5095#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5096 at input.c:530
5097530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5098@end group
5099@end smallexample
5100
5101@item set print address off
5102Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5103this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5104
5105@smallexample
5106@group
5107(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5108(@value{GDBP}) f
5109#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5110530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5111@end group
5112@end smallexample
5113
5114You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5115dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5116@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5117all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5118
5119@kindex show print address
5120@item show print address
5121Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5122@end table
5123
5124When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5125closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5126identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5127source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5128@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5129you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5130it prints a symbolic address:
5131
5132@table @code
5133@kindex set print symbol-filename
5134@item set print symbol-filename on
5135Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5136symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5137
5138@item set print symbol-filename off
5139Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5140default.
5141
5142@kindex show print symbol-filename
5143@item show print symbol-filename
5144Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5145line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5146@end table
5147
5148Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5149numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5150number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5151
5152Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5153printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5154
5155@table @code
5156@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5157@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5158Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5159offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5160@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5161to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5162
5163@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5164@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5165Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5166symbolic address.
5167@end table
5168
5169@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5170@cindex pointer, finding referent
5171If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5172@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5173and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5174@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5175For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5176at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5177
474c8240 5178@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5179(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5180(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5181$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5182@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@quotation
5185@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5186does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5187the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5188@end quotation
5189
5190Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5191
5192@table @code
5193@kindex set print array
5194@item set print array
5195@itemx set print array on
5196Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5197but uses more space. The default is off.
5198
5199@item set print array off
5200Return to compressed format for arrays.
5201
5202@kindex show print array
5203@item show print array
5204Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5205arrays.
5206
5207@kindex set print elements
5208@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5209Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5210If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5211printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5212This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5213When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5214Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5215
5216@kindex show print elements
5217@item show print elements
5218Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5219If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5220
5221@kindex set print null-stop
5222@item set print null-stop
5223Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5224@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5225contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5226The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5227
5228@kindex set print pretty
5229@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5230Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5231per line, like this:
5232
5233@smallexample
5234@group
5235$1 = @{
5236 next = 0x0,
5237 flags = @{
5238 sweet = 1,
5239 sour = 1
5240 @},
5241 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5242@}
5243@end group
5244@end smallexample
5245
5246@item set print pretty off
5247Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5248
5249@smallexample
5250@group
5251$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5252meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5253@end group
5254@end smallexample
5255
5256@noindent
5257This is the default format.
5258
5259@kindex show print pretty
5260@item show print pretty
5261Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5262
5263@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5264@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5265Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5266@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5267character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5268best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5269high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5270
5271@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5272Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5273international character sets, and is the default.
5274
5275@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5276@item show print sevenbit-strings
5277Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5278
5279@kindex set print union
5280@item set print union on
5d161b24 5281Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5282is the default setting.
5283
5284@item set print union off
5285Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5286
5287@kindex show print union
5288@item show print union
5289Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5290structures.
5291
5292For example, given the declarations
5293
5294@smallexample
5295typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5296typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5297typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5298 Bug_forms;
5299
5300struct thing @{
5301 Species it;
5302 union @{
5303 Tree_forms tree;
5304 Bug_forms bug;
5305 @} form;
5306@};
5307
5308struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5309@end smallexample
5310
5311@noindent
5312with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5313
5314@smallexample
5315$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5316@end smallexample
5317
5318@noindent
5319and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5320
5321@smallexample
5322$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5323@end smallexample
5324@end table
5325
c906108c
SS
5326@need 1000
5327@noindent
b37052ae 5328These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5329
5330@table @code
5331@cindex demangling
5332@kindex set print demangle
5333@item set print demangle
5334@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5335Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5336(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5337linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5338
5339@kindex show print demangle
5340@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5341Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5342
5343@kindex set print asm-demangle
5344@item set print asm-demangle
5345@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5346Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5347in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5348The default is off.
5349
5350@kindex show print asm-demangle
5351@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5352Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5353or demangled form.
5354
5355@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5356@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5357@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5358@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5359Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5360represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5361
5362@table @code
5363@item auto
5364Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5365
5366@item gnu
b37052ae 5367Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5368This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5369
5370@item hp
b37052ae 5371Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5372
5373@item lucid
b37052ae 5374Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5375
5376@item arm
b37052ae 5377Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5378@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5379debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5380require further enhancement to permit that.
5381
5382@end table
5383If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5384
5385@kindex show demangle-style
5386@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5387Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5388
5389@kindex set print object
5390@item set print object
5391@itemx set print object on
5392When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5393(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5394the virtual function table.
5395
5396@item set print object off
5397Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5398virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5399
5400@kindex show print object
5401@item show print object
5402Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5403
5404@kindex set print static-members
5405@item set print static-members
5406@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5407Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5408
5409@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5410Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5411
5412@kindex show print static-members
5413@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5414Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5415
5416@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5417@kindex set print vtbl
5418@item set print vtbl
5419@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5420Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5421(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5422ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5423
5424@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5425Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5426
5427@kindex show print vtbl
5428@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5429Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5430@end table
c906108c 5431
6d2ebf8b 5432@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5433@section Value history
5434
5435@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5436Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5437@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5438Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5439(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5440When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5441since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5442symbol table.
5443
5444@cindex @code{$}
5445@cindex @code{$$}
5446@cindex history number
5447The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5448refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5449@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5450printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5451history number.
5452
5453To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5454history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5455remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5456the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5457@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5458is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5459@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5460
5461For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5462want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5463
474c8240 5464@smallexample
c906108c 5465p *$
474c8240 5466@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5467
5468If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5469to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5470
474c8240 5471@smallexample
c906108c 5472p *$.next
474c8240 5473@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5474
5475@noindent
5476You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5477command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5478
5479Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5480@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5481
474c8240 5482@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5483print x
5484set x=5
474c8240 5485@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5486
5487@noindent
5488then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5489remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5490
5491@table @code
5492@kindex show values
5493@item show values
5494Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5495This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5496values} does not change the history.
5497
5498@item show values @var{n}
5499Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5500
5501@item show values +
5502Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5503values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5504@end table
5505
5506Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5507same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5508
6d2ebf8b 5509@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5510@section Convenience variables
5511
5512@cindex convenience variables
5513@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5514@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5515exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5516setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5517of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5518
5519Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5520@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5521the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5522(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5523by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5524
5525You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5526expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5527For example:
5528
474c8240 5529@smallexample
c906108c 5530set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5532
5533@noindent
5534would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5535@code{object_ptr}.
5536
5537Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5538value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5539value with another assignment at any time.
5540
5541Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5542variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5543that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5544variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5545
5546@table @code
5547@kindex show convenience
5548@item show convenience
5549Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5550Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5551@end table
5552
5553One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5554incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5555a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5556
474c8240 5557@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5558set $i = 0
5559print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5560@end smallexample
c906108c 5561
d4f3574e
SS
5562@noindent
5563Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5564
5565Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5566values likely to be useful.
5567
5568@table @code
41afff9a 5569@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5570@item $_
5571The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5572the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5573commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5574set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5575and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5576except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5577to the type of @code{$__}.
5578
41afff9a 5579@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5580@item $__
5581The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5582to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5583to match the format in which the data was printed.
5584
5585@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5586@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5587The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5588the program being debugged terminates.
5589@end table
5590
53a5351d
JM
5591On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5592begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5593name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5594
6d2ebf8b 5595@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5596@section Registers
5597
5598@cindex registers
5599You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5600with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5601for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5602your machine.
5603
5604@table @code
5605@kindex info registers
5606@item info registers
5607Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5608and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5609
5610@kindex info all-registers
5611@cindex floating point registers
5612@item info all-registers
5613Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5614and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5615
5616@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5617Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5618As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5619the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5620the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5621@end table
5622
5623@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5624expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5625architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5626@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5627the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5628pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5629register that contains the processor status. For example,
5630you could print the program counter in hex with
5631
474c8240 5632@smallexample
c906108c 5633p/x $pc
474c8240 5634@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5635
5636@noindent
5637or print the instruction to be executed next with
5638
474c8240 5639@smallexample
c906108c 5640x/i $pc
474c8240 5641@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5642
5643@noindent
5644or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5645one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5646memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5647stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5648stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5649regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5650see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5651
474c8240 5652@smallexample
c906108c 5653set $sp += 4
474c8240 5654@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5655
5656Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5657your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5658so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5659shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5660registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5661can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5662is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5663
5664@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5665integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5666special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5667registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5668to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5669(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5670@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5671
5672Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5673means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5674the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5675sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5676coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5677programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5678cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5679that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5680prints the data in both formats.
5681
5682Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5683(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5684value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5685were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5686true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5687frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5688
5689However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5690code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5691@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5692frame makes no difference.
5693
6d2ebf8b 5694@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5695@section Floating point hardware
5696@cindex floating point
5697
5698Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5699you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5700
5701@table @code
5702@kindex info float
5703@item info float
5704Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5705point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5706floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5707the ARM and x86 machines.
5708@end table
c906108c 5709
e76f1f2e
AC
5710@node Vector Unit
5711@section Vector Unit
5712@cindex vector unit
5713
5714Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5715more information about the status of the vector unit.
5716
5717@table @code
5718@kindex info vector
5719@item info vector
5720Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5721layout vary depending on the hardware.
5722@end table
5723
29e57380 5724@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5725@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5726@cindex memory region attributes
5727
5728@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5729required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5730to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5731use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5732
5733Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5734memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5735accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5736been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5737all memory.
5738
5739When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5740to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5741
5742@table @code
5743@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5744@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5745Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5746attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5747special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5748(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5749
5750@kindex delete mem
5751@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5752Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5753
5754@kindex disable mem
5755@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5756Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5757A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5758It may be enabled again later.
5759
5760@kindex enable mem
5761@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5762Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5763
5764@kindex info mem
5765@item info mem
5766Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5767for each region.
5768
5769@table @emph
5770@item Memory Region Number
5771@item Enabled or Disabled.
5772Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5773Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5774
5775@item Lo Address
5776The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5777
5778@item Hi Address
5779The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5780
5781@item Attributes
5782The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5783@end table
5784@end table
5785
5786
5787@subsection Attributes
5788
5789@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5790The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5791write accesses to a memory region.
5792
5793While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5794memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5795etc. from accessing memory.
5796
5797@table @code
5798@item ro
5799Memory is read only.
5800@item wo
5801Memory is write only.
5802@item rw
6ca652b0 5803Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5804@end table
5805
5806@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5807The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5808accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5809require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5810specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5811
5812@table @code
5813@item 8
5814Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5815@item 16
5816Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5817@item 32
5818Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5819@item 64
5820Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5821@end table
5822
5823@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5824@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5825@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5826@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5827@c
5828@c @table @code
5829@c @item hwbreak
5830@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5831@c @item swbreak (default)
5832@c @end table
5833
5834@subsubsection Data Cache
5835The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5836memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5837protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5838does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5839registers.
5840
5841@table @code
5842@item cache
5843Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5844@item nocache
5845Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5846@end table
5847
5848@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5849@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5850@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5851@c
5852@c @table @code
5853@c @item verify
5854@c @item noverify (default)
5855@c @end table
5856
16d9dec6
MS
5857@node Dump/Restore Files
5858@section Copy between memory and a file
5859@cindex dump/restore files
5860@cindex append data to a file
5861@cindex dump data to a file
5862@cindex restore data from a file
5863@kindex dump
5864@kindex append
5865@kindex restore
5866
5867The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5868for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5869into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5870file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5871intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5872
5873@table @code
5874@kindex dump binary
5875@kindex append binary
5876@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5877Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5878raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5879
5880@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5881Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5882raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5883
5884@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5885Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5886
5887@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5888Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5889
5890@kindex dump ihex
5891@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5892Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5893intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5894
5895@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5896Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5897
5898@kindex dump srec
5899@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5900Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5901srec format file @var{filename}.
5902
5903@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5904Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5905
5906@kindex dump tekhex
5907@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5908Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5909tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5910
5911@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5912Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5913
42f9b0a5 5914@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5915Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5916command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5917raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5918@var{binary} after the filename.
5919
5920If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5921contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5922they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5923a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5924from that location.
5925
5926If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5927file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5928These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5929the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5930
5931@end table
5932
a0eb71c5
KB
5933@node Character Sets
5934@section Character Sets
5935@cindex character sets
5936@cindex charset
5937@cindex translating between character sets
5938@cindex host character set
5939@cindex target character set
5940
5941If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5942represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5943@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5944you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5945character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5946@dfn{target character set}.
5947
5948For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5949uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5950remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5951running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5952then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5953@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5954target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5955@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5956character and string literals in expressions.
5957
5958@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5959the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5960target-charset} command, described below.
5961
5962Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5963support:
5964
5965@table @code
5966@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5967@kindex set target-charset
5968Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5969character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5970@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5971the character sets it supports.
5972@end table
5973
5974@table @code
5975@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5976@kindex set host-charset
5977Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5978
5979By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5980system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5981@code{set host-charset} command.
5982
5983@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5984set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5985indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5986@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5987character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5988it can use as a host character set.
5989
5990@item set charset @var{charset}
5991@kindex set charset
5992Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5993invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5994character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5995sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5996asterisk (@samp{*}).
5997
5998@item show charset
5999@itemx show host-charset
6000@itemx show target-charset
6001@kindex show charset
6002@kindex show host-charset
6003@kindex show target-charset
6004Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
6005and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
6006charset}.
6007
6008@end table
6009
6010@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6011sets:
6012
6013@table @code
6014
6015@item ASCII
6016@cindex ASCII character set
6017Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6018character set.
6019
6020@item ISO-8859-1
6021@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6022@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6023The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
6024characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6025this as its host character set.
6026
6027@item EBCDIC-US
6028@itemx IBM1047
6029@cindex EBCDIC character set
6030@cindex IBM1047 character set
6031Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6032mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6033@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6034
6035@end table
6036
6037Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6038GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6039encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6040
6041Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6042Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6043@file{charset-test.c}:
6044
6045@smallexample
6046#include <stdio.h>
6047
6048char ascii_hello[]
6049 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6050 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6051char ibm1047_hello[]
6052 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6053 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6054
6055main ()
6056@{
6057 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6058@}
10998722 6059@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6060
6061In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6062containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6063encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6064
6065We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6066
6067@smallexample
6068$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6069$ gdb -nw charset-test
6070GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6071Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6072@dots{}
6073(gdb)
10998722 6074@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6075
6076We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6077@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6078strings:
6079
6080@smallexample
6081(gdb) show charset
6082The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6083(gdb)
10998722 6084@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6085
6086For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6087initial character set:
6088@smallexample
6089(gdb) set charset ascii
6090(gdb) show charset
6091The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6092(gdb)
10998722 6093@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6094
6095Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6096host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6097characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6098them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6099@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6100
6101@smallexample
6102(gdb) print ascii_hello
6103$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6104(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6105$2 = 72 'H'
6106(gdb)
10998722 6107@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6108
6109@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6110literals you use in expressions:
6111
6112@smallexample
6113(gdb) print '+'
6114$3 = 43 '+'
6115(gdb)
10998722 6116@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6117
6118The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6119character.
6120
6121@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6122target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6123character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6124
6125@smallexample
6126(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6127$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6128(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6129$5 = 200 '\310'
6130(gdb)
10998722 6131@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6132
6133If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6134@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6135
6136@smallexample
6137(gdb) set target-charset
6138Valid character sets are:
6139 ascii *
6140 iso-8859-1 *
6141 ebcdic-us
6142 ibm1047
6143* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6144@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6145
6146We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6147program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6148@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6149target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6150@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6151
6152@smallexample
6153(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6154(gdb) show charset
6155The current host character set is `ascii'.
6156The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6157(gdb) print ascii_hello
6158$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6159(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6160$7 = 72 '\110'
6161(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6162$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6163(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6164$9 = 200 'H'
6165(gdb)
10998722 6166@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6167
6168As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6169string literals you use in expressions:
6170
6171@smallexample
6172(gdb) print '+'
6173$10 = 78 '+'
6174(gdb)
10998722 6175@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6176
6177The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6178character.
6179
6180
e2e0bcd1
JB
6181@node Macros
6182@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6183
6184Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6185``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6186@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6187the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6188where it was defined.
6189
6190You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6191with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6192include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6193with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6194
6195A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6196and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6197points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6198no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6199uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6200@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6201see @ref{List}.
6202
6203At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6204token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6205variable-arity macros.
6206
6207Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6208macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6209the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6210
6211@table @code
6212
6213@kindex macro expand
6214@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6215@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6216@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6217@item macro expand @var{expression}
6218@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6219Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6220@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6221not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6222it can be any string of tokens.
6223
6224@kindex macro expand-once
6225@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6226@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6227@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6228expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6229@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6230left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6231particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6232expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6233parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6234can be any string of tokens.
6235
475b0867 6236@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6237@cindex macro definition, showing
6238@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6239@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6240Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6241source location where that definition was established.
6242
6243@kindex macro define
6244@cindex user-defined macros
6245@cindex defining macros interactively
6246@cindex macros, user-defined
6247@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6248@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6249@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6250preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6251by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6252command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6253second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6254given in @var{arglist}.
6255
6256A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6257evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6258undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6259definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6260well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6261
6262@kindex macro undef
6263@item macro undef @var{macro}
6264@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6265definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6266definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6267above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6268debugged.
6269
6270@end table
6271
6272@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6273Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6274show our source files:
6275
6276@smallexample
6277$ cat sample.c
6278#include <stdio.h>
6279#include "sample.h"
6280
6281#define M 42
6282#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6283
6284main ()
6285@{
6286#define N 28
6287 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6288#undef N
6289 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6290#define N 1729
6291 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6292@}
6293$ cat sample.h
6294#define Q <
6295$
6296@end smallexample
6297
6298Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6299We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6300compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6301information.
6302
6303@smallexample
6304$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6305$
6306@end smallexample
6307
6308Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6309
6310@smallexample
6311$ gdb -nw sample
6312GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6313Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6314GDB is free software, @dots{}
6315(gdb)
6316@end smallexample
6317
6318We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6319program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6320to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6321
6322@smallexample
6323(gdb) list main
63243
63254 #define M 42
63265 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
63276
63287 main ()
63298 @{
63309 #define N 28
633110 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
633211 #undef N
633312 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6334(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6335Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6336#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6337(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6338Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6339 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6340#define Q <
6341(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6342expands to: (42 + 1)
6343(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6344expands to: once (M + 1)
6345(gdb)
6346@end smallexample
6347
6348In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6349the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6350@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6351which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6352
6353Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6354the source line of the current stack frame:
6355
6356@smallexample
6357(gdb) break main
6358Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6359(gdb) run
6360Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6361
6362Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
636310 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6364(gdb)
6365@end smallexample
6366
6367At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6368
6369@smallexample
475b0867 6370(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6371Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6372#define N 28
6373(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6374expands to: 28 < 42
6375(gdb) print N Q M
6376$1 = 1
6377(gdb)
6378@end smallexample
6379
6380As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6381give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6382thereof) in force at each point:
6383
6384@smallexample
6385(gdb) next
6386Hello, world!
638712 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6388(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6389The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6390at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6391(gdb) next
6392We're so creative.
639314 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6394(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6395Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6396#define N 1729
6397(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6398expands to: 1729 < 42
6399(gdb) print N Q M
6400$2 = 0
6401(gdb)
6402@end smallexample
6403
6404
b37052ae
EZ
6405@node Tracepoints
6406@chapter Tracepoints
6407@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6408@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6409
6410@cindex tracepoints
6411In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6412the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6413anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6414depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6415might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6416fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6417to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6418
6419Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6420specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6421arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6422Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6423those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6424expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6425for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6426a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6427in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6428values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6429unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6430
6431The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6432targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6433to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6434stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6435tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6436
6437This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6438
6439@menu
6440* Set Tracepoints::
6441* Analyze Collected Data::
6442* Tracepoint Variables::
6443@end menu
6444
6445@node Set Tracepoints
6446@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6447
6448Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6449tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6450tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6451breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6452one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6453tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6454work on.
6455
6456For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6457of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6458it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6459local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6460commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6461tracepoint was hit.
6462
6463This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6464conditions and actions.
6465
6466@menu
6467* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6468* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6469* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6470* Tracepoint Actions::
6471* Listing Tracepoints::
6472* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6473@end menu
6474
6475@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6476@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6477
6478@table @code
6479@cindex set tracepoint
6480@kindex trace
6481@item trace
6482The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6483Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6484the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6485defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6486debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6487program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6488doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6489cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6490running.
6491
6492Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6493
6494@smallexample
6495(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6496
6497(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6498
6499(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6500
6501(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6502
6503(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6504@end smallexample
6505
6506@noindent
6507You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6508
6509@vindex $tpnum
6510@cindex last tracepoint number
6511@cindex recent tracepoint number
6512@cindex tracepoint number
6513The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6514of the most recently set tracepoint.
6515
6516@kindex delete tracepoint
6517@cindex tracepoint deletion
6518@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6519Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6520default is to delete all tracepoints.
6521
6522Examples:
6523
6524@smallexample
6525(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6526
6527(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6528@end smallexample
6529
6530@noindent
6531You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6532@end table
6533
6534@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6535@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6536
6537@table @code
6538@kindex disable tracepoint
6539@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6540Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6541@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6542the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6543a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6544
6545@kindex enable tracepoint
6546@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6547Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6548tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6549run.
6550@end table
6551
6552@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6553@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6554
6555@table @code
6556@kindex passcount
6557@cindex tracepoint pass count
6558@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6559Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6560automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6561@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6562the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6563@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6564passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6565given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6566user.
6567
6568Examples:
6569
6570@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6571(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6572@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6573
6574(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6575@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6576(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6580(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6581(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6582@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6583@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6584@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6585@end smallexample
6586@end table
6587
6588@node Tracepoint Actions
6589@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6590
6591@table @code
6592@kindex actions
6593@cindex tracepoint actions
6594@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6595This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6596tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6597specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6598recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6599@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6600actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6601terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6602far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6603@code{while-stepping}.
6604
6605@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6606To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6607and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6608
6609@smallexample
6610(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6611
6826cf00 6612(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6613
6826cf00 6614(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6615@end smallexample
6616
6617In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6618commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6619hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6620following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6621followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6622@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6623@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6624@code{end} command.
6625
6626@smallexample
6627(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6628(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6629Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6630> collect bar,baz
6631> collect $regs
6632> while-stepping 12
6633 > collect $fp, $sp
6634 > end
6635end
6636@end smallexample
6637
6638@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6639@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6640Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6641This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6642In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6643special arguments are supported:
6644
6645@table @code
6646@item $regs
6647collect all registers
6648
6649@item $args
6650collect all function arguments
6651
6652@item $locals
6653collect all local variables.
6654@end table
6655
6656You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6657with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6658arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6659
f5c37c66
EZ
6660The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6661particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6662
b37052ae
EZ
6663@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6664@item while-stepping @var{n}
6665Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6666new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6667followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6668its own @code{end} command):
6669
6670@smallexample
6671> while-stepping 12
6672 > collect $regs, myglobal
6673 > end
6674>
6675@end smallexample
6676
6677@noindent
6678You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6679@code{stepping}.
6680@end table
6681
6682@node Listing Tracepoints
6683@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6684
6685@table @code
6686@kindex info tracepoints
6687@cindex information about tracepoints
6688@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6689Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6690a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6691defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6692shown:
6693
6694@itemize @bullet
6695@item
6696its number
6697@item
6698whether it is enabled or disabled
6699@item
6700its address
6701@item
6702its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6703@item
6704its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6705@item
6706where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6707@item
6708its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6709@end itemize
6710
6711@smallexample
6712(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6713Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
67141 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
67152 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
67163 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6717(@value{GDBP})
6718@end smallexample
6719
6720@noindent
6721This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6722@end table
6723
6724@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6725@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6726
6727@table @code
6728@kindex tstart
6729@cindex start a new trace experiment
6730@cindex collected data discarded
6731@item tstart
6732This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6733begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6734the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6735experiment.
6736
6737@kindex tstop
6738@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6739@item tstop
6740This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6741stops collecting data.
6742
6743@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6744automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6745(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6746
6747@kindex tstatus
6748@cindex status of trace data collection
6749@cindex trace experiment, status of
6750@item tstatus
6751This command displays the status of the current trace data
6752collection.
6753@end table
6754
6755Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6756
6757@smallexample
6758(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6759(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6760Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6761> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6762> while-stepping 11
6763 > collect $regs
6764 > end
6765> end
6766(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6767 [time passes @dots{}]
6768(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6769@end smallexample
6770
6771
6772@node Analyze Collected Data
6773@section Using the collected data
6774
6775After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6776for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6777collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6778snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6779consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6780examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6781specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6782snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6783registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6784rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6785debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6786(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6787behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6788when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6789the buffer will fail.
6790
6791@menu
6792* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6793* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6794* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6795@end menu
6796
6797@node tfind
6798@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6799
6800@kindex tfind
6801@cindex select trace snapshot
6802@cindex find trace snapshot
6803The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6804@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6805counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6806snapshot is selected.
6807
6808Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6809
6810@table @code
6811@item tfind start
6812Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6813@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6814
6815@item tfind none
6816Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6817
6818@item tfind end
6819Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6820
6821@item tfind
6822No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6823
6824@item tfind -
6825Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6826retracing earlier steps.
6827
6828@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6829Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6830proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6831argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6832for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6833
6834@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6835Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6836program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6837snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6838snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6839
6840@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6841Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6842addresses.
6843
6844@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6845Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6846@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6847
6848@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6849Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6850the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6851that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6852trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6853next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6854@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6855stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6856@end table
6857
6858The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6859designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6860instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6861snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6862trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6863simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6864snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6865@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6866The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6867for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6868no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6869(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6870no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6871tracepoint as the current one.
6872
6873In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6874these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6875scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6876you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6877registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6878
6879@smallexample
6880(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6881(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6882> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6883 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6884> tfind
6885> end
6886
6887Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6888Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6889Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6890Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6891Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6892Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6893Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6894Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6895Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6896Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6897Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6898@end smallexample
6899
6900Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6901the buffer:
6902
6903@smallexample
6904(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6905(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6906> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6907> tfind line
6908> end
6909
6910Frame 0, X = 1
6911Frame 7, X = 2
6912Frame 13, X = 255
6913@end smallexample
6914
6915@node tdump
6916@subsection @code{tdump}
6917@kindex tdump
6918@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6919@cindex tracepoint data, display
6920
6921This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6922the current trace snapshot.
6923
6924@smallexample
6925(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6926(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6927Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6928> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6929> end
6930
6931(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6932
6933(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6934#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6935at gdb_test.c:444
6936444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6937
6938(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6939Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6940d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6941d1 0x18 24
6942d2 0x80 128
6943d3 0x33 51
6944d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6945d5 0x22 34
6946d6 0xe0 224
6947d7 0x380035 3670069
6948a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6949a1 0x3000668 50333288
6950a2 0x100 256
6951a3 0x322000 3284992
6952a4 0x3000698 50333336
6953a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6954fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6955sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6956ps 0x0 0
6957pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6958fpcontrol 0x0 0
6959fpstatus 0x0 0
6960fpiaddr 0x0 0
6961p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6962p1 = (void *) 0x11
6963p2 = (void *) 0x22
6964p3 = (void *) 0x33
6965p4 = (void *) 0x44
6966p5 = (void *) 0x55
6967p6 = (void *) 0x66
6968gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6969
6970(@value{GDBP})
6971@end smallexample
6972
6973@node save-tracepoints
6974@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6975@kindex save-tracepoints
6976@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6977
6978This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6979their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6980suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6981tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6982Files}).
6983
6984@node Tracepoint Variables
6985@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6986@cindex tracepoint variables
6987@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6988
6989@table @code
6990@vindex $trace_frame
6991@item (int) $trace_frame
6992The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6993snapshot is selected.
6994
6995@vindex $tracepoint
6996@item (int) $tracepoint
6997The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6998
6999@vindex $trace_line
7000@item (int) $trace_line
7001The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7002
7003@vindex $trace_file
7004@item (char []) $trace_file
7005The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7006
7007@vindex $trace_func
7008@item (char []) $trace_func
7009The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7010@end table
7011
7012Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7013use @code{output} instead.
7014
7015Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7016stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7017data.
7018
7019@smallexample
7020(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7021
7022(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7023> output $trace_file
7024> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7025> tfind
7026> end
7027@end smallexample
7028
df0cd8c5
JB
7029@node Overlays
7030@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7031@cindex overlays
7032
7033If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7034memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7035problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7036use overlays.
7037
7038@menu
7039* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7040* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7041* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7042 mapped by asking the inferior.
7043* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7044@end menu
7045
7046@node How Overlays Work
7047@section How Overlays Work
7048@cindex mapped overlays
7049@cindex unmapped overlays
7050@cindex load address, overlay's
7051@cindex mapped address
7052@cindex overlay area
7053
7054Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7055kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7056other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7057management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7058adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7059
7060One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7061independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7062@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7063their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7064instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7065largest overlay as well.
7066
7067Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7068overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7069for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7070there.
7071
c928edc0
AC
7072@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7073@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7074@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7075
474c8240 7076@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7077@group
c928edc0
AC
7078 Data Instruction Larger
7079Address Space Address Space Address Space
7080+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7081| | | | | |
7082+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7083| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7084| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7085| and heap | | | | | |
7086+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7087| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7088+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7089 | | | | | |
7090 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7091 address | | | | | |
7092 | overlay | <-' | | |
7093 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7094 | | <---. | | load address
7095 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7096 | | | |
7097 +-----------+ | |
7098 +-----------+
7099 | |
7100 +-----------+
7101
7102 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7103@end group
474c8240 7104@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7105
c928edc0
AC
7106The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7107and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7108its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7109Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7110may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7111data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7112program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7113program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7114
7115An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7116@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7117instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7118in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7119is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7120the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7121called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7122
7123Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7124program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7125global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7126
7127@itemize @bullet
7128
7129@item
7130Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7131must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7132return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7133overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7134
7135@item
7136If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7137will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7138your program's performance.
7139
7140@item
7141The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7142overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7143mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7144and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7145You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7146addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7147ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7148
7149@item
7150The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7151to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7152instruction and data spaces.
7153
7154@end itemize
7155
7156The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7157improved in many ways:
7158
7159@itemize @bullet
7160
7161@item
7162If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7163hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7164contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7165This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7166area in the usual way.
7167
7168@item
7169If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7170overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7171
7172@item
7173You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7174general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7175code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7176return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7177the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7178must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7179different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7180
7181@end itemize
7182
7183
7184@node Overlay Commands
7185@section Overlay Commands
7186
7187To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7188correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7189virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7190mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7191@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7192variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7193
7194@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7195you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7196
7197@table @code
7198@item overlay off
7199@kindex overlay off
7200Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7201disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7202always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7203overlay support is disabled.
7204
7205@item overlay manual
7206@kindex overlay manual
7207@cindex manual overlay debugging
7208Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7209relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7210using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7211commands described below.
7212
7213@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7214@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7215@kindex overlay map-overlay
7216@cindex map an overlay
7217Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7218be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7219overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7220functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7221that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7222@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7223
7224@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7225@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7226@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7227@cindex unmap an overlay
7228Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7229must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7230When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7231overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7232
7233@item overlay auto
7234@kindex overlay auto
7235Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7236consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7237to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7238Overlay Debugging}.
7239
7240@item overlay load-target
7241@itemx overlay load
7242@kindex overlay load-target
7243@cindex reloading the overlay table
7244Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7245re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7246stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7247overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7248useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7249
7250@item overlay list-overlays
7251@itemx overlay list
7252@cindex listing mapped overlays
7253Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7254addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7255
7256@end table
7257
7258Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7259of the function the address falls in:
7260
474c8240 7261@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7262(gdb) print main
7263$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7264@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7265@noindent
7266When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7267unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7268asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7269unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7270
474c8240 7271@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7272(gdb) overlay list
7273No sections are mapped.
7274(gdb) print foo
7275$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7276@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7277@noindent
7278When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7279name normally:
7280
474c8240 7281@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7282(gdb) overlay list
7283Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7284 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7285(gdb) print foo
7286$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7287@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7288
7289When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7290address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7291overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7292@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7293code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7294
7295@itemize @bullet
7296@item
7297@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7298@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7299You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7300@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7301@item
7302@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7303unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7304overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7305you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7306breakpoints properly.
7307@end itemize
7308
7309
7310@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7311@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7312@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7313
7314@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7315are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7316inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7317@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7318looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7319current state of the overlays.
7320
7321Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7322@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7323
7324@table @asis
7325
7326@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7327This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7328
474c8240 7329@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7330struct
7331@{
7332 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7333 unsigned long vma;
7334
7335 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7336 unsigned long size;
7337
7338 /* The overlay's load address. */
7339 unsigned long lma;
7340
7341 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7342 zero otherwise. */
7343 unsigned long mapped;
7344@}
474c8240 7345@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7346
7347@item @code{_novlys}:
7348This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7349number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7350
7351@end table
7352
7353To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7354looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7355@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7356executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7357the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7358currently mapped.
7359
81d46470 7360In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7361@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7362will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7363calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7364will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7365are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7366in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7367overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7368are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7369
7370@node Overlay Sample Program
7371@section Overlay Sample Program
7372@cindex overlay example program
7373
7374When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7375at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7376addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7377Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7378since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7379architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7380portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7381
7382However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7383program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7384suite. The program consists of the following files from
7385@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7386
7387@table @file
7388@item overlays.c
7389The main program file.
7390@item ovlymgr.c
7391A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7392@item foo.c
7393@itemx bar.c
7394@itemx baz.c
7395@itemx grbx.c
7396Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7397@item d10v.ld
7398@itemx m32r.ld
7399Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7400and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7401@end table
7402
7403You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7404cross-compiler like this:
7405
474c8240 7406@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7407$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7408$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7409$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7410$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7411$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7412$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7413$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7414 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7415@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7416
7417The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7418you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7419target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7420
7421
6d2ebf8b 7422@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7423@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7424@cindex languages
7425
c906108c
SS
7426Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7427rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7428dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7429Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7430represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7431@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7432
7433@cindex working language
7434Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7435allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7436native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7437consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7438language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7439language}.
7440
7441@menu
7442* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7443* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7444* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7445* Support:: Supported languages
7446@end menu
7447
6d2ebf8b 7448@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7449@section Switching between source languages
7450
7451There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7452set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7453@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7454defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7455used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7456are printed, etc.
7457
7458In addition to the working language, every source file that
7459@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7460file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7461source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7462language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7463controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7464show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7465set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7466set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7467Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7468
7469This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7470as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7471another language. In that case, make the
7472program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7473@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7474program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7475
7476@menu
7477* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7478* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7479* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7480@end menu
7481
6d2ebf8b 7482@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7483@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7484
7485If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7486@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7487
7488@table @file
7489
7490@item .c
7491C source file
7492
7493@item .C
7494@itemx .cc
7495@itemx .cp
7496@itemx .cpp
7497@itemx .cxx
7498@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7499C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7500
7501@item .f
7502@itemx .F
7503Fortran source file
7504
c906108c
SS
7505@item .mod
7506Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7507
7508@item .s
7509@itemx .S
7510Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7511@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7512@end table
7513
7514In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7515extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7516
6d2ebf8b 7517@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7518@subsection Setting the working language
7519
7520If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7521expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7522your program.
7523
7524@kindex set language
7525If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7526command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7527a language, such as
c906108c 7528@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7529For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7530
c906108c
SS
7531Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7532language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7533to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7534source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7535languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7536source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7537command such as:
7538
474c8240 7539@smallexample
c906108c 7540print a = b + c
474c8240 7541@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7542
7543@noindent
7544might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7545@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7546printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7547@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7548
6d2ebf8b 7549@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7550@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7551
7552To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7553@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7554then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7555frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7556working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7557frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7558or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7559does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7560not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7561
7562This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7563entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7564written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7565a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7566case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7567
6d2ebf8b 7568@node Show
c906108c 7569@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7570
7571The following commands help you find out which language is the
7572working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7573
7574@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7575@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7576@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7577@table @code
7578@item show language
7579Display the current working language. This is the
7580language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7581build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7582
7583@item info frame
5d161b24 7584Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7585working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7586@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7587information listed here.
7588
7589@item info source
7590Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7591@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7592information listed here.
7593@end table
7594
7595In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7596not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7597with a language explicitly:
7598
7599@kindex set extension-language
7600@kindex info extensions
7601@table @code
7602@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7603Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7604the source language @var{language}.
7605
7606@item info extensions
7607List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7608@end table
7609
6d2ebf8b 7610@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7611@section Type and range checking
7612
7613@quotation
7614@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7615checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7616section documents the intended facilities.
7617@end quotation
7618@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7619
7620Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7621errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7622checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7623sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7624these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7625by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7626errors when your program is running.
7627
7628@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7629Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7630can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7631the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7632@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7633your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7634for the default settings of supported languages.
7635
7636@menu
7637* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7638* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7639@end menu
7640
7641@cindex type checking
7642@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7643@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7644@subsection An overview of type checking
7645
7646Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7647arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7648otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7649errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7650
7651@smallexample
76521 + 2 @result{} 3
7653@exdent but
7654@error{} 1 + 2.3
7655@end smallexample
7656
7657The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7658type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7659
5d161b24
DB
7660For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7661@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7662to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7663or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7664but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7665these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7666also issues a warning.
7667
5d161b24
DB
7668Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7669related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7670For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7671a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7672with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7673the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7674
7675Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7676instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7677operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7678represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7679operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7680details on specific languages.
7681
7682@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7683
d4f3574e 7684@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7685@kindex set check type
7686@kindex show check type
7687@table @code
7688@item set check type auto
7689Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7690@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7691each language.
7692
7693@item set check type on
7694@itemx set check type off
7695Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7696current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7697match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7698evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7699message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7700
7701@item set check type warn
7702Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7703evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7704be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7705numbers and structures.
7706
7707@item show type
5d161b24 7708Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7709is setting it automatically.
7710@end table
7711
7712@cindex range checking
7713@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7714@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7715@subsection An overview of range checking
7716
7717In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7718bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7719checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7720computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7721not exceed the bounds of the array.
7722
7723For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7724@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7725always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7726warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7727
7728A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7729array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7730of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7731error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7732result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7733the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7734
474c8240 7735@smallexample
c906108c 7736@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7737@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7738
7739This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7740specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7741Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7742
7743@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7744
d4f3574e 7745@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7746@kindex set check range
7747@kindex show check range
7748@table @code
7749@item set check range auto
7750Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7751@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7752each language.
7753
7754@item set check range on
7755@itemx set check range off
7756Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7757current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7758match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7759then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7760
7761@item set check range warn
7762Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7763but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7764expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7765memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7766systems).
7767
7768@item show range
7769Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7770being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7771@end table
c906108c 7772
6d2ebf8b 7773@node Support
c906108c 7774@section Supported languages
c906108c 7775
e632838e 7776@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7777@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7778Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7779language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7780and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7781,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7782language.
7783
7784The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7785supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7786tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7787@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7788formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7789books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7790language reference or tutorial.
7791
c906108c 7792@menu
b37052ae 7793* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7794* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7795@end menu
7796
6d2ebf8b 7797@node C
b37052ae 7798@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7799
b37052ae
EZ
7800@cindex C and C@t{++}
7801@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7802
b37052ae 7803Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7804to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7805together.
7806
41afff9a
EZ
7807@cindex C@t{++}
7808@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7809@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7810The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7811compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7812effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7813C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7814compiler (@code{aCC}).
7815
0179ffac
DC
7816For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7817format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7818format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7819command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7820@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7821CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
c906108c 7822
c906108c 7823@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7824* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7825* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7826* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7827* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7828* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7829* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7830* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7831@end menu
c906108c 7832
6d2ebf8b 7833@node C Operators
b37052ae 7834@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7835
b37052ae 7836@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7837
7838Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7839@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7840often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7841
b37052ae 7842For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7843
7844@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7845
c906108c 7846@item
c906108c 7847@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7848specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7849
7850@item
d4f3574e
SS
7851@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7852@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7853
7854@item
53a5351d 7855@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7856
7857@item
7858@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7859
c906108c
SS
7860@end itemize
7861
7862@noindent
7863The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7864in order of increasing precedence:
7865
7866@table @code
7867@item ,
7868The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7869are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7870expression being the last expression evaluated.
7871
7872@item =
7873Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7874assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7875
7876@item @var{op}=
7877Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7878and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7879@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7880@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7881@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7882
7883@item ?:
7884The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7885of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7886integral type.
7887
7888@item ||
7889Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7890
7891@item &&
7892Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7893
7894@item |
7895Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7896
7897@item ^
7898Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7899
7900@item &
7901Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7902
7903@item ==@r{, }!=
7904Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7905expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7906
7907@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7908Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7909Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7910and non-zero for true.
7911
7912@item <<@r{, }>>
7913left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7914
7915@item @@
7916The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7917
7918@item +@r{, }-
7919Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7920pointer types.
7921
7922@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7923Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7924defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7925integral types.
7926
7927@item ++@r{, }--
7928Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7929operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7930when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7931operation takes place.
7932
7933@item *
7934Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7935@code{++}.
7936
7937@item &
7938Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7939
b37052ae
EZ
7940For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7941allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7942(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7943where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7944stored.
c906108c
SS
7945
7946@item -
7947Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7948precedence as @code{++}.
7949
7950@item !
7951Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7952@code{++}.
7953
7954@item ~
7955Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7956@code{++}.
7957
7958
7959@item .@r{, }->
7960Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7961@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7962pointer based on the stored type information.
7963Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7964
c906108c
SS
7965@item .*@r{, }->*
7966Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7967
7968@item []
7969Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7970@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7971
7972@item ()
7973Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7974
c906108c 7975@item ::
b37052ae 7976C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7977and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7978
7979@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7980Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7981(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7982above.
c906108c
SS
7983@end table
7984
c906108c
SS
7985If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7986attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7987predefined meaning.
c906108c 7988
c906108c 7989@menu
5d161b24 7990* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7991@end menu
7992
6d2ebf8b 7993@node C Constants
b37052ae 7994@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7995
b37052ae 7996@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7997
b37052ae 7998@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7999following ways:
c906108c
SS
8000
8001@itemize @bullet
8002@item
8003Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8004specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8005by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8006@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8007@code{long} value.
8008
8009@item
8010Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8011point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8012exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8013@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8014sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8015A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8016@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8017the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8018a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8019constant.
c906108c
SS
8020
8021@item
8022Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8023integral equivalents.
8024
8025@item
8026Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8027(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8028(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8029be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8030the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8031of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8032@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8033@samp{\n} for newline.
8034
8035@item
96a2c332
SS
8036String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8037double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8038above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8039a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8040characters.
c906108c
SS
8041
8042@item
8043Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8044to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8045
8046@item
8047Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8048and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8049integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8050and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8051@end itemize
8052
c906108c 8053@menu
5d161b24
DB
8054* C plus plus expressions::
8055* C Defaults::
8056* C Checks::
c906108c 8057
5d161b24 8058* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8059@end menu
8060
6d2ebf8b 8061@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8062@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8063
8064@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8065@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8066
0179ffac
DC
8067@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8068@cindex C@t{++} compilers
8069@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8070@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
c906108c 8071@quotation
b37052ae 8072@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
0179ffac
DC
8073proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8074works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8075@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8076@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8077stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8078stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8079specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8080are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8081C@t{++} code.
c906108c 8082@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8083
8084@enumerate
8085
8086@cindex member functions
8087@item
8088Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8089
474c8240 8090@smallexample
c906108c 8091count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8092@end smallexample
c906108c 8093
41afff9a 8094@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8095@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8096@item
8097While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8098expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8099that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8100pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8101
c906108c 8102@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8103@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8104@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8105@item
8106You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8107call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8108perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8109calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8110in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8111default arguments.
8112
8113It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8114promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8115class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8116functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8117number of function arguments.
8118
8119Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8120@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8121,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8122
d4f3574e 8123You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8124explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8125@smallexample
8126p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8127@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8128
c906108c 8129The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8130see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8131
c906108c
SS
8132@cindex reference declarations
8133@item
b37052ae
EZ
8134@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8135them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8136dereferenced.
8137
8138In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8139reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8140avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8141The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8142you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8143
8144@item
b37052ae 8145@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8146expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8147one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8148necessary, for example in an expression like
8149@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8150resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8151debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8152@end enumerate
8153
b37052ae 8154In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8155calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8156objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8157invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8158
6d2ebf8b 8159@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8160@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8161
b37052ae 8162@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8163
c906108c
SS
8164If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8165both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8166C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8167selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8168
8169If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8170recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8171@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8172these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8173@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8174for further details.
8175
c906108c
SS
8176@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8177@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8178@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8179
6d2ebf8b 8180@node C Checks
b37052ae 8181@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8182
b37052ae 8183@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8184
b37052ae 8185By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8186is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8187considers two variables type equivalent if:
8188
8189@itemize @bullet
8190@item
8191The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8192enumerated tag.
8193
8194@item
8195The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8196declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8197
8198@ignore
8199@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8200@c FIXME--beers?
8201@item
8202The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8203declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8204compilers.)
8205@end ignore
8206@end itemize
8207
8208Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8209indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8210that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8211
6d2ebf8b 8212@node Debugging C
c906108c 8213@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8214
8215The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8216the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8217inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8218appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8219
8220The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8221with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8222,Expressions}.
8223
c906108c 8224@menu
5d161b24 8225* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8226@end menu
8227
6d2ebf8b 8228@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8229@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8230
b37052ae 8231@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8232
b37052ae
EZ
8233Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8234designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8235
8236@table @code
8237@cindex break in overloaded functions
8238@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8239When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8240@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8241you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8242
b37052ae 8243@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8244@item rbreak @var{regex}
8245Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8246breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8247classes.
8248@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8249
b37052ae 8250@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8251@item catch throw
8252@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8253Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8254Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8255
8256@cindex inheritance
8257@item ptype @var{typename}
8258Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8259@var{typename}.
8260@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8261
b37052ae 8262@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8263@item set print demangle
8264@itemx show print demangle
8265@itemx set print asm-demangle
8266@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8267Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8268displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8269@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8270
8271@item set print object
8272@itemx show print object
8273Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8274@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8275
8276@item set print vtbl
8277@itemx show print vtbl
8278Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8279@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8280(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8281ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8282
8283@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8284@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8285@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8286Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8287is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8288and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8289using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8290expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8291message.
8292
8293@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8294Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8295overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8296chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8297symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8298overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8299searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8300argument types.
c906108c
SS
8301
8302@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8303You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8304the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8305@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8306also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8307available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8308@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8309@end table
c906108c 8310
6d2ebf8b 8311@node Modula-2
c906108c 8312@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8313
d4f3574e 8314@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8315
8316The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8317output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8318developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8319attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8320to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8321table.
8322
8323@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8324@menu
8325* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8326* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8327* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8328* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8329* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8330* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8331* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8332* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8333@end menu
8334
6d2ebf8b 8335@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8336@subsubsection Operators
8337@cindex Modula-2 operators
8338
8339Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8340@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8341often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8342following definitions hold:
8343
8344@itemize @bullet
8345
8346@item
8347@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8348their subranges.
8349
8350@item
8351@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8352
8353@item
8354@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8355
8356@item
8357@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8358@var{type}}.
8359
8360@item
8361@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8362
8363@item
8364@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8365
8366@item
8367@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8368@end itemize
8369
8370@noindent
8371The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8372increasing precedence:
8373
8374@table @code
8375@item ,
8376Function argument or array index separator.
8377
8378@item :=
8379Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8380@var{value}.
8381
8382@item <@r{, }>
8383Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8384types.
8385
8386@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8387Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8388on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8389set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8390
8391@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8392Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8393Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8394available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8395comment character.
8396
8397@item IN
8398Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8399Same precedence as @code{<}.
8400
8401@item OR
8402Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8403
8404@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8405Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8406
8407@item @@
8408The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8409
8410@item +@r{, }-
8411Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8412and difference on set types.
8413
8414@item *
8415Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8416on set types.
8417
8418@item /
8419Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8420types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8421
8422@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8423Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8424precedence as @code{*}.
8425
8426@item -
8427Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8428
8429@item ^
8430Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8431
8432@item NOT
8433Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8434@code{^}.
8435
8436@item .
8437@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8438precedence as @code{^}.
8439
8440@item []
8441Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8442
8443@item ()
8444Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8445as @code{^}.
8446
8447@item ::@r{, }.
8448@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8449@end table
8450
8451@quotation
8452@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8453treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8454@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8455@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8456@end quotation
8457
cb51c4e0 8458
6d2ebf8b 8459@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8460@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8461@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8462
8463Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8464In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8465
8466@table @var
8467
8468@item a
8469represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8470
8471@item c
8472represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8473
8474@item i
8475represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8476
8477@item m
8478represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8479same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8480be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8481
8482@item n
8483represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8484
8485@item r
8486represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8487
8488@item t
8489represents a type.
8490
8491@item v
8492represents a variable.
8493
8494@item x
8495represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8496explanation of the function for details.
8497@end table
8498
8499All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8500
8501@table @code
8502@item ABS(@var{n})
8503Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8504
8505@item CAP(@var{c})
8506If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8507equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8508
8509@item CHR(@var{i})
8510Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8511
8512@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8513Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8514
8515@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8516Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8517new value.
8518
8519@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8520Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8521set.
8522
8523@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8524Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8525
8526@item HIGH(@var{a})
8527Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8528
8529@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8530Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8531
8532@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8533Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8534new value.
8535
8536@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8537Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8538there. Returns the new set.
8539
8540@item MAX(@var{t})
8541Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8542
8543@item MIN(@var{t})
8544Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8545
8546@item ODD(@var{i})
8547Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8548
8549@item ORD(@var{x})
8550Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8551value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8552@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8553integral, character and enumerated types.
8554
8555@item SIZE(@var{x})
8556Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8557
8558@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8559Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8560
8561@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8562Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8563@end table
8564
8565@quotation
8566@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8567@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8568an error.
8569@end quotation
8570
8571@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8572@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8573@subsubsection Constants
8574
8575@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8576ways:
8577
8578@itemize @bullet
8579
8580@item
8581Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8582expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8583rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8584trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8585
8586@item
8587Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8588decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8589then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8590@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8591digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8592digits.
8593
8594@item
8595Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8596like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8597also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8598followed by a @samp{C}.
8599
8600@item
8601String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8602pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8603Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8604Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8605sequences.
8606
8607@item
8608Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8609
8610@item
8611Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8612@code{FALSE}.
8613
8614@item
8615Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8616
8617@item
8618Set constants are not yet supported.
8619@end itemize
8620
6d2ebf8b 8621@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8622@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8623@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8624
8625If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8626both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8627Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8628selected the working language.
8629
8630If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8631code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8632working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8633the language automatically}, for further details.
8634
6d2ebf8b 8635@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8636@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8637@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8638
8639A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8640This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8641
8642@itemize @bullet
8643@item
8644Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8645integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8646debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8647pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8648through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8649returned a pointer.)
8650
8651@item
8652C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8653non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8654escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8655printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8656
8657@item
8658The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8659argument.
8660
8661@item
8662All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8663@end itemize
8664
6d2ebf8b 8665@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8666@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8667@cindex Modula-2 checks
8668
8669@quotation
8670@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8671range checking.
8672@end quotation
8673@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8674
8675@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8676
8677@itemize @bullet
8678@item
8679They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8680@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8681
8682@item
8683They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8684@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8685@end itemize
8686
8687As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8688whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8689
8690Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8691index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8692
6d2ebf8b 8693@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8694@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8695@cindex scope
41afff9a 8696@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8697@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8698@ifinfo
41afff9a 8699@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8700@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8701@end ifinfo
8702@iftex
41afff9a 8703@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8704@end iftex
8705
8706There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8707(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8708similar syntax:
8709
474c8240 8710@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8711
8712@var{module} . @var{id}
8713@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8714@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8715
8716@noindent
8717where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8718@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8719identifier within your program, except another module.
8720
8721Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8722specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8723found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8724enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8725
8726Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8727the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8728definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8729an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8730module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8731@var{module}.
8732
6d2ebf8b 8733@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8734@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8735
8736Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8737Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8738specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8739@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8740apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8741analogue in Modula-2.
8742
8743The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8744with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8745intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8746created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8747address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8748@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8749
8750@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8751In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8752interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8753
6d2ebf8b 8754@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8755@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8756
d4f3574e 8757The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8758symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8759program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8760does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8761program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8762(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8763file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8764
8765@cindex symbol names
8766@cindex names of symbols
8767@cindex quoting names
8768Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8769characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8770most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8771source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8772are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8773ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8774@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8775@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8776
474c8240 8777@smallexample
c906108c 8778p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8779@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8780
8781@noindent
8782looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8783
8784@table @code
8785@kindex info address
b37052ae 8786@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8787@item info address @var{symbol}
8788Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8789variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8790local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8791is always stored.
8792
8793Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8794at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8795the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8796
3d67e040 8797@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8798@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8799@item info symbol @var{addr}
8800Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8801If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8802nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8803
474c8240 8804@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8805(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8806_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8807@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8808
8809@noindent
8810This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8811it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8812
c906108c 8813@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8814@item whatis @var{expr}
8815Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8816actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8817assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8818@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8819
8820@item whatis
8821Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8822
8823@kindex ptype
8824@item ptype @var{typename}
8825Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8826the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8827@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8828@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8829
d4f3574e 8830@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8831@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8832Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8833differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8834of just the name of the type.
8835
8836For example, for this variable declaration:
8837
474c8240 8838@smallexample
c906108c 8839struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8840@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8841
8842@noindent
8843the two commands give this output:
8844
474c8240 8845@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8846@group
8847(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8848type = struct complex
8849(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8850type = struct complex @{
8851 double real;
8852 double imag;
8853@}
8854@end group
474c8240 8855@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8856
8857@noindent
8858As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8859the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8860
8861@kindex info types
8862@item info types @var{regexp}
8863@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8864Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8865(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8866complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8867@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8868names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8869information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8870
8871This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8872@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8873lists all source files where a type is defined.
8874
b37052ae
EZ
8875@kindex info scope
8876@cindex local variables
8877@item info scope @var{addr}
8878List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8879accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8880preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8881scope defined by that location. For example:
8882
8883@smallexample
8884(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8885Scope for command_line_handler:
8886Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8887Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8888Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8889Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8890Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8891Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8892Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8893@end smallexample
8894
f5c37c66
EZ
8895@noindent
8896This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8897during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8898collect}.
8899
c906108c
SS
8900@kindex info source
8901@item info source
919d772c
JB
8902Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8903the function containing the current point of execution:
8904@itemize @bullet
8905@item
8906the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8907@item
8908the directory it was compiled in,
8909@item
8910its length, in lines,
8911@item
8912which programming language it is written in,
8913@item
8914whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8915if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8916@item
8917whether the debugging information includes information about
8918preprocessor macros.
8919@end itemize
8920
c906108c
SS
8921
8922@kindex info sources
8923@item info sources
8924Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8925debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8926have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8927
8928@kindex info functions
8929@item info functions
8930Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8931
8932@item info functions @var{regexp}
8933Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8934whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8935Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8936include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8937start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8938that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8939@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8940
8941@kindex info variables
8942@item info variables
8943Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8944outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8945
8946@item info variables @var{regexp}
8947Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8948variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8949@var{regexp}.
8950
8951@ignore
8952This was never implemented.
8953@kindex info methods
8954@item info methods
8955@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8956The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8957methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8958specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8959C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8960from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8961@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8962which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8963@end ignore
8964
c906108c
SS
8965@cindex reloading symbols
8966Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8967be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8968in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8969running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8970@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8971
8972@table @code
8973@kindex set symbol-reloading
8974@item set symbol-reloading on
8975Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8976object file with a particular name is seen again.
8977
8978@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8979Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8980same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8981running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8982should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8983may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8984several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8985name.
c906108c
SS
8986
8987@kindex show symbol-reloading
8988@item show symbol-reloading
8989Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8990@end table
c906108c 8991
c906108c
SS
8992@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8993@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8994Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8995declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8996@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8997source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8998another source file. The default is on.
8999
9000A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9001the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9002
9003@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9004Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9005is printed as follows:
9006@smallexample
9007@{<no data fields>@}
9008@end smallexample
9009
9010@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9011@item show opaque-type-resolution
9012Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9013
9014@kindex maint print symbols
9015@cindex symbol dump
9016@kindex maint print psymbols
9017@cindex partial symbol dump
9018@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9019@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9020@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9021Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9022These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9023symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9024symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9025collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9026only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9027command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9028use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9029symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9030files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9031@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9032required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9033@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9034@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9035@end table
9036
6d2ebf8b 9037@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9038@chapter Altering Execution
9039
9040Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9041find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9042correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9043experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9044program.
9045
9046For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9047locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9048address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9049
9050@menu
9051* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9052* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9053* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9054* Returning:: Returning from a function
9055* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9056* Patching:: Patching your program
9057@end menu
9058
6d2ebf8b 9059@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9060@section Assignment to variables
9061
9062@cindex assignment
9063@cindex setting variables
9064To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9065@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9066
474c8240 9067@smallexample
c906108c 9068print x=4
474c8240 9069@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9070
9071@noindent
9072stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9073value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9074@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9075information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9076
9077@kindex set variable
9078@cindex variables, setting
9079If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9080@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9081really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9082not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9083,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9084
c906108c
SS
9085If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9086appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9087variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9088to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9089program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9090a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9091command @code{set width}:
9092
474c8240 9093@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9094(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9095type = double
9096(@value{GDBP}) p width
9097$4 = 13
9098(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9099Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9100@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9101
9102@noindent
9103The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9104order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9105
474c8240 9106@smallexample
c906108c 9107(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9108@end smallexample
53a5351d 9109
c906108c
SS
9110Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9111with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9112@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9113your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9114to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9115the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9116
474c8240 9117@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9118@group
9119(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9120type = double
9121(@value{GDBP}) p g
9122$1 = 1
9123(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9124(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9125$2 = 1
9126(@value{GDBP}) r
9127The program being debugged has been started already.
9128Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9129Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9130"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9131 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9132(@value{GDBP}) show g
9133The current BFD target is "=4".
9134@end group
474c8240 9135@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9136
9137@noindent
9138The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9139@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9140@code{g}, use
9141
474c8240 9142@smallexample
c906108c 9143(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9144@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9145
9146@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9147freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9148and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9149same length or shorter.
9150@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9151@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9152
9153To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9154construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9155(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9156to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9157and representation in memory), and
9158
474c8240 9159@smallexample
c906108c 9160set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9161@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9162
9163@noindent
9164stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9165
6d2ebf8b 9166@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9167@section Continuing at a different address
9168
9169Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9170it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9171an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9172
9173@table @code
9174@kindex jump
9175@item jump @var{linespec}
9176Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9177immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9178source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9179@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9180in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9181breakpoints}.
9182
9183The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9184the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9185register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9186a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9187be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9188of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9189confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9190executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9191well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9192
9193@item jump *@var{address}
9194Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9195@end table
9196
c906108c 9197@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9198On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9199command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9200difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9201changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9202example,
c906108c 9203
474c8240 9204@smallexample
c906108c 9205set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9206@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9207
9208@noindent
9209makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9210address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9211@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9212
9213The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9214up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9215that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9216detail.
9217
c906108c 9218@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9219@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9220@section Giving your program a signal
9221
9222@table @code
9223@kindex signal
9224@item signal @var{signal}
9225Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9226signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9227signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9228SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9229
9230Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9231giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9232a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9233@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9234signal.
9235
9236@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9237after executing the command.
9238@end table
9239@c @end group
9240
9241Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9242@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9243causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9244the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9245passes the signal directly to your program.
9246
c906108c 9247
6d2ebf8b 9248@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9249@section Returning from a function
9250
9251@table @code
9252@cindex returning from a function
9253@kindex return
9254@item return
9255@itemx return @var{expression}
9256You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9257command. If you give an
9258@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9259value.
9260@end table
9261
9262When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9263(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9264discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9265be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9266
9267This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9268frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9269innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9270specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9271of functions.
9272
9273The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9274program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9275returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9276and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9277selected stack frame returns naturally.
9278
6d2ebf8b 9279@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9280@section Calling program functions
9281
9282@cindex calling functions
9283@kindex call
9284@table @code
9285@item call @var{expr}
9286Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9287returned values.
9288@end table
9289
9290You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9291execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9292with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9293is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9294
6d2ebf8b 9295@node Patching
c906108c 9296@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9297
c906108c
SS
9298@cindex patching binaries
9299@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9300@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9301
7a292a7a
SS
9302By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9303executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9304alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9305patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9306
9307If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9308explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9309want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9310repairs.
9311
9312@table @code
9313@kindex set write
9314@item set write on
9315@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9316If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9317core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9318off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9319
9320If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9321@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9322write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9323
9324@item show write
9325@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9326Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9327as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9328@end table
9329
6d2ebf8b 9330@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9331@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9332
7a292a7a
SS
9333@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9334both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9335program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9336@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9337
9338@menu
9339* Files:: Commands to specify files
5b5d99cf 9340* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
c906108c
SS
9341* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9342@end menu
9343
6d2ebf8b 9344@node Files
c906108c 9345@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9346
7a292a7a 9347@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9348@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9349
9350You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9351way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9352@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9353Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9354
9355Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9356@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9357a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9358to specify new files are useful.
9359
9360@table @code
9361@cindex executable file
9362@kindex file
9363@item file @var{filename}
9364Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9365symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9366executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9367directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9368@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9369directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9370to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9371and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9372
6d2ebf8b 9373On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9374@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9375@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9376@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9377descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9378(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9379@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9380for more information.
c906108c
SS
9381
9382@item file
9383@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9384has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9385
9386@kindex exec-file
9387@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9388Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9389in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9390if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9391discard information on the executable file.
9392
9393@kindex symbol-file
9394@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9395Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9396searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9397table and program to run from the same file.
9398
9399@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9400program's symbol table.
9401
5d161b24 9402The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9403of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9404auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9405the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9406the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9407
9408@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9409executing it once.
9410
9411When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9412understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9413generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9414other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9415Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9416using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9417optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9418
9419For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9420using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9421symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9422quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9423details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9424
9425The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9426start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9427occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9428file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9429pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9430warnings and messages}.)
9431
c906108c
SS
9432We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9433symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9434symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9435still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9436in stabs format.
9437
9438@kindex readnow
9439@cindex reading symbols immediately
9440@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9441@kindex mapped
9442@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9443@cindex saving symbol table
9444@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9445@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9446You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9447tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9448load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9449entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9450
c906108c
SS
9451If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9452@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9453cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9454file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9455from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9456than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9457program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9458starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9459
9460You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9461file has all the symbol information for your program.
9462
9463The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9464@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9465than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9466it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9467needed.
9468
9469The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9470@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9471symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9472
9473@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9474@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9475@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9476@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9477@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9478@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9479@c files.
9480
9481@kindex core
9482@kindex core-file
9483@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9484Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9485of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9486address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9487executable file itself for other parts.
9488
9489@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9490to be used.
9491
9492Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9493under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9494wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9495the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9496(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9497
c906108c
SS
9498@kindex add-symbol-file
9499@cindex dynamic linking
9500@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9501@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9502@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9503The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9504information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9505when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9506into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9507address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9508this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9509of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9510section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9511@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9512
9513The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9514originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9515@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9516thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9517instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9518
17d9d558
JB
9519@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9520@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9521@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9522@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9523@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9524Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9525executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9526relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9527information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9528
9529@itemize @bullet
9530@item
9531the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9532that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9533@item
9534every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9535been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9536@item
9537you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9538provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9539@end itemize
9540
9541@noindent
9542Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9543relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9544typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9545important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9546procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9547assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9548general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9549relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9550as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9551way.
9552
c906108c
SS
9553@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9554
9555You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9556the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9557table information for @var{filename}.
9558
9559@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9560@item add-shared-symbol-file
9561The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9562operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9563shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9564@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9565
c906108c
SS
9566@kindex section
9567@item section
5d161b24
DB
9568The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9569the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9570section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9571specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9572separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9573the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9574
9575@kindex info files
9576@kindex info target
9577@item info files
9578@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9579@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9580current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9581including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9582use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9583command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9584current ones.
9585
fe95c787
MS
9586@kindex maint info sections
9587@item maint info sections
9588Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9589is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9590displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9591offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9592@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9593may be arbitrarily combined):
9594
9595@table @code
9596@item ALLOBJ
9597Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9598@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9599Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9600@item @var{section-flags}
9601Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9602The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9603@table @code
9604@item ALLOC
9605Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9606Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9607@item LOAD
9608Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9609Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9610@item RELOC
9611Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9612@item READONLY
9613Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9614@item CODE
9615Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9616@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9617Section contains data only (no executable code).
9618@item ROM
9619Section will reside in ROM.
9620@item CONSTRUCTOR
9621Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9622@item HAS_CONTENTS
9623Section is not empty.
9624@item NEVER_LOAD
9625An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9626@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9627A notification to the linker that the section contains
9628COFF shared library information.
9629@item IS_COMMON
9630Section contains common symbols.
9631@end table
9632@end table
6763aef9
MS
9633@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9634@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9635Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9636really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9637In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9638out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9639For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9640enhancement to debugging performance.
9641
9642The default is off.
9643
9644@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9645Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9646the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9647and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9648@end table
9649
9650All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9651as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9652name and remembers it that way.
9653
c906108c 9654@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9655@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9656libraries.
53a5351d 9657
c906108c
SS
9658@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9659when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9660(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9661references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9662debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9663
9664On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9665automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9666
c906108c
SS
9667@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9668@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9669@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9670
b7209cb4
FF
9671There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9672symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9673particularly large or there are many of them.
9674
9675To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9676commands:
9677
9678@table @code
9679@kindex set auto-solib-add
9680@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9681If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9682will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9683attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9684informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9685is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9686@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9687
9688@kindex show auto-solib-add
9689@item show auto-solib-add
9690Display the current autoloading mode.
9691@end table
9692
9693To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9694command:
9695
c906108c
SS
9696@table @code
9697@kindex info sharedlibrary
9698@kindex info share
9699@item info share
9700@itemx info sharedlibrary
9701Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9702
9703@kindex sharedlibrary
9704@kindex share
9705@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9706@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9707Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9708Unix regular expression.
9709As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9710required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9711@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9712loaded.
9713@end table
9714
b7209cb4
FF
9715On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9716autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9717reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9718by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9719up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9720wish.
c906108c
SS
9721
9722Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9723loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9724@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9725automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9726
9727To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9728
9729@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9730@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9731@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9732Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9733If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9734symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9735size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9736Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9737@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9738Mb).
c906108c 9739
b7209cb4
FF
9740@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9741@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9742Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9743@end table
c906108c 9744
f5ebfba0
DJ
9745Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9746configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9747host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9748copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9749not.
9750
9751You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9752load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9753@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9754libraries.
9755
9756@table @code
9757@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9758@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9759If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9760absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9761paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9762@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9763out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9764@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9765
9766You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9767configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9768
9769@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9770@item show solib-absolute-prefix
9771Display the current shared library prefix.
9772
9773@kindex set solib-search-path
9774@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9775If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9776to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9777@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9778the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9779@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9780set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9781@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9782
9783@kindex show solib-search-path
9784@item show solib-search-path
9785Display the current shared library search path.
9786@end table
9787
5b5d99cf
JB
9788
9789@node Separate Debug Files
9790@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9791@cindex separate debugging information files
9792@cindex debugging information in separate files
9793@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
9794@cindex debugging information directory, global
9795@cindex global debugging information directory
9796
9797@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
9798file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
9799@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
9800Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
9801than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
9802information for their executables in separate files, which users can
9803install only when they need to debug a problem.
9804
9805If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
9806separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
9807the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
9808components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
9809debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
9810containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
9811debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
9812will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
9813places:
9814
9815@itemize @bullet
9816@item
9817the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
9818for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
9819@item
9820a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
9821file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
9822@item
9823a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
9824executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
9825@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
9826@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
9827@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
9828@end itemize
9829@noindent
9830@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
9831information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
9832reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
9833
9834So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
9835which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
9836debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
9837for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
9838@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
9839@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
9840
9841You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
9842name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
9843
9844@table @code
9845
9846@kindex set debug-file-directory
9847@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
9848Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9849information files to @var{directory}.
9850
9851@kindex show debug-file-directory
9852@item show debug-file-directory
9853Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9854information files.
9855
9856@end table
9857
9858@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
9859@cindex debug links
9860A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
9861@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
9862
9863@itemize
9864@item
9865A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
9866a zero byte,
9867@item
9868zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
9869boundary within the section, and
9870@item
9871a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
9872executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
9873information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
9874zero as the @var{crc} argument.
9875@end itemize
9876
9877Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
9878contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
9879described above.
9880
9881The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
9882executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
9883debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
9884should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
9885but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
9886in an ordinary executable.
9887
9888As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
9889separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
9890Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
9891contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
9892@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
9893the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
9894@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
9895
9896Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
9897polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
9898describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
9899complete code for a function that computes it:
9900
9901@kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
9902@smallexample
9903unsigned long
9904gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
9905 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
9906@{
9907 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
9908 @{
9909 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
9910 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
9911 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
9912 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
9913 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
9914 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
9915 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
9916 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
9917 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
9918 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
9919 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
9920 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
9921 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
9922 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
9923 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
9924 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
9925 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
9926 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
9927 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
9928 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
9929 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
9930 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
9931 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
9932 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
9933 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
9934 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
9935 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
9936 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
9937 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
9938 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
9939 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
9940 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
9941 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
9942 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
9943 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
9944 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
9945 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
9946 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
9947 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
9948 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
9949 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
9950 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
9951 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
9952 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
9953 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
9954 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
9955 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
9956 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
9957 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
9958 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
9959 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
9960 0x2d02ef8d
9961 @};
9962 unsigned char *end;
9963
9964 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
9965 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
9966 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
9967 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;;
9968@}
9969@end smallexample
9970
9971
6d2ebf8b 9972@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9973@section Errors reading symbol files
9974
9975While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9976such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9977output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9978they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9979debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9980about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9981only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9982times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9983to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9984complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9985messages}).
9986
9987The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9988
9989@table @code
9990@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9991
9992The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9993(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9994error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9995in its outer scope blocks.
9996
9997@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9998the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9999may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10000function.
10001
10002@item block at @var{address} out of order
10003
10004The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10005order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10006do so.
10007
10008@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10009locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10010can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10011@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10012messages}.)
10013
10014@item bad block start address patched
10015
10016The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10017smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10018to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10019
10020@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10021starting on the previous source line.
10022
10023@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10024
10025@cindex foo
10026Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10027larger than the size of the string table.
10028
10029@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10030name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10031with this name.
10032
10033@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10034
7a292a7a
SS
10035The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10036not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10037uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10038
7a292a7a
SS
10039@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10040This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10041are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10042debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10043on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10044and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10045
10046@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10047
7a292a7a 10048@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10049
7a292a7a 10050@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10051The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10052information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10053it.
c906108c
SS
10054
10055@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10056
10057@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10058
c906108c
SS
10059@end table
10060
6d2ebf8b 10061@node Targets
c906108c 10062@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10063
c906108c
SS
10064@cindex debugging target
10065@kindex target
10066
10067A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10068
10069Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10070in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10071you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10072flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10073host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10074realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10075command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10076(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10077
10078@menu
10079* Active Targets:: Active targets
10080* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10081* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10082* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10083* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10084
10085@end menu
10086
6d2ebf8b 10087@node Active Targets
c906108c 10088@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10089
c906108c
SS
10090@cindex stacking targets
10091@cindex active targets
10092@cindex multiple targets
10093
c906108c 10094There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10095executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10096active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10097start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10098a core file.
c906108c
SS
10099
10100For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10101@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10102well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10103@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10104first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10105requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10106are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10107read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10108executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10109
10110When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10111target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10112commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10113an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10114process target is active.
c906108c 10115
7a292a7a
SS
10116Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10117core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10118files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10119the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10120process}).
c906108c 10121
6d2ebf8b 10122@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10123@section Commands for managing targets
10124
10125@table @code
10126@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10127Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10128process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10129facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10130protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10131
10132Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10133typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10134with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10135
10136The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10137after executing the command.
10138
10139@kindex help target
10140@item help target
10141Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10142currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10143(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10144
10145@item help target @var{name}
10146Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10147select it.
10148
10149@kindex set gnutarget
10150@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10151@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10152knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10153a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10154with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10155with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10156
d4f3574e 10157@quotation
c906108c
SS
10158@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10159you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10160@end quotation
c906108c 10161
d4f3574e
SS
10162@noindent
10163@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10164
5d161b24 10165@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10166@item show gnutarget
10167Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10168@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10169@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10170and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10171@end table
10172
c906108c
SS
10173Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10174configuration):
c906108c
SS
10175
10176@table @code
10177@kindex target exec
10178@item target exec @var{program}
10179An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10180@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10181
c906108c
SS
10182@kindex target core
10183@item target core @var{filename}
10184A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10185@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10186
10187@kindex target remote
10188@item target remote @var{dev}
10189Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10190specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10191@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10192supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10193some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10194it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10195
c906108c
SS
10196@kindex target sim
10197@item target sim
2df3850c 10198Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10199In general,
474c8240 10200@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10201 target sim
10202 load
10203 run
474c8240 10204@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10205@noindent
104c1213 10206works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10207drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10208provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10209see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10210Processors}.
10211
c906108c
SS
10212@end table
10213
104c1213 10214Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10215
10216@table @code
10217
c906108c
SS
10218@kindex target nrom
10219@item target nrom @var{dev}
10220NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10221
c906108c
SS
10222@end table
10223
5d161b24 10224Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10225your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10226
10227Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10228once you've successfully established a connection.
10229
10230@table @code
10231
10232@kindex load @var{filename}
10233@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10234Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10235@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10236is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10237on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10238@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10239the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10240
10241If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10242execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10243target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10244
10245The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10246For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10247link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10248specifies a fixed address.
10249@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10250
c906108c
SS
10251@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10252@end table
10253
6d2ebf8b 10254@node Byte Order
c906108c 10255@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10256
c906108c
SS
10257@cindex choosing target byte order
10258@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10259
10260Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10261offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10262orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10263designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10264which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10265@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10266
10267@table @code
10268@kindex set endian big
10269@item set endian big
10270Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10271
10272@kindex set endian little
10273@item set endian little
10274Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10275
10276@kindex set endian auto
10277@item set endian auto
10278Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10279executable.
10280
10281@item show endian
10282Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10283
10284@end table
10285
10286Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10287data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10288target system.
10289
6d2ebf8b 10290@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10291@section Remote debugging
10292@cindex remote debugging
10293
10294If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10295@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10296For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10297or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10298powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10299
10300Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10301to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10302@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10303but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10304write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10305communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10306
10307Other remote targets may be available in your
10308configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10309
6f05cf9f
AC
10310@node KOD
10311@section Kernel Object Display
10312
10313@cindex kernel object display
10314@cindex kernel object
10315@cindex KOD
10316
10317Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10318@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10319and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10320mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10321displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10322
10323Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10324@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10325
474c8240 10326@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10327(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10328@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10329
10330If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10331about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10332which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10333after the operating system:
c906108c 10334
474c8240 10335@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10336(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10337List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10338Object Description
10339any Any and all objects
474c8240 10340@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10341
10342Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10343by the kernel.
10344
10345There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10346is supported other than to try it.
10347
10348
10349@node Remote Debugging
10350@chapter Debugging remote programs
10351
6b2f586d
AC
10352@menu
10353* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10354* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10355* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10356@end menu
10357
6f05cf9f
AC
10358@node Server
10359@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10360
10361@kindex gdbserver
10362@cindex remote connection without stubs
10363@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10364allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10365@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10366
10367@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10368because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10369that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10370@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10371@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10372because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10373also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10374started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10375Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10376the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10377do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10378by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10379choice for debugging.
10380
10381@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10382or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10383protocol.
10384
10385@table @emph
10386@item On the target machine,
10387you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10388@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10389strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10390system does all the symbol handling.
10391
10392To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10393the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10394syntax is:
10395
10396@smallexample
10397target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10398@end smallexample
10399
10400@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10401hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10402@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10403@file{/dev/com1}:
10404
10405@smallexample
10406target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10407@end smallexample
10408
10409@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10410with it.
10411
10412To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10413
10414@smallexample
10415target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10416@end smallexample
10417
10418The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10419specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10420TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10421expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10422(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10423you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10424TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10425reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10426conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10427and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10428@code{target remote} command.
10429
56460a61
DJ
10430On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10431This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10432
10433@smallexample
10434target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10435@end smallexample
10436
10437@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10438to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10439
6f05cf9f
AC
10440@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10441you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10442symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10443using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10444(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10445running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10446remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10447is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10448@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10449@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10450
10451@smallexample
10452(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10453@end smallexample
10454
10455@noindent
10456communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10457
10458@smallexample
10459(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10460@end smallexample
10461
10462@noindent
10463communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10464For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10465the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10466text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10467@samp{Connection refused}.
10468@end table
10469
10470@node NetWare
10471@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10472
10473@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10474@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10475allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10476@code{target remote}.
10477
10478@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10479using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10480
10481@table @emph
10482@item On the target machine,
10483you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10484@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10485can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10486host system does all the symbol handling.
10487
10488To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10489@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10490program. The syntax is:
10491
10492@smallexample
10493load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10494 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10495@end smallexample
10496
10497@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10498the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10499to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10500
10501For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10502communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10503using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10504
10505@smallexample
10506load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10507@end smallexample
10508
10509@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10510you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10511symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10512using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10513(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10514running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10515remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10516argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10517@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10518
10519@smallexample
10520(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10521@end smallexample
10522
10523@noindent
10524communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10525@end table
10526
10527@node remote stub
10528@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10529
8e04817f
AC
10530@cindex debugging stub, example
10531@cindex remote stub, example
10532@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10533The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10534communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10535@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10536these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10537implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10538with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10539organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10540
104c1213
JM
10541@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10542To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10543@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10544prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10545program, you need:
c906108c 10546
104c1213
JM
10547@enumerate
10548@item
10549A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10550have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10551your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10552
5d161b24 10553@item
d4f3574e 10554A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10555subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10556
104c1213
JM
10557@item
10558A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10559download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10560manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10561documentation.
10562@end enumerate
96baa820 10563
104c1213
JM
10564The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10565communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10566machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10567
104c1213
JM
10568@table @emph
10569@item On the host,
10570@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10571else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10572(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10573
10574@item On the target,
10575you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10576implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10577subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10578
10579On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10580@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10581@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10582@end table
96baa820 10583
104c1213
JM
10584The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10585machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10586@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10587
104c1213
JM
10588@cindex remote serial stub list
10589These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10590
104c1213
JM
10591@table @code
10592
10593@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10594@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10595@cindex Intel
10596@cindex i386
10597For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10598
10599@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10600@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10601@cindex Motorola 680x0
10602@cindex m680x0
10603For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10604
10605@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10606@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10607@cindex Hitachi
10608@cindex SH
10609For Hitachi SH architectures.
10610
10611@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10612@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10613@cindex Sparc
10614For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10615
10616@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10617@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10618@cindex Fujitsu
10619@cindex SparcLite
10620For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10621
10622@end table
10623
10624The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10625recently added stubs.
10626
10627@menu
10628* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10629* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10630* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10631@end menu
10632
6d2ebf8b 10633@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10634@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10635
10636@cindex remote serial stub
10637The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10638subroutines:
10639
10640@table @code
10641@item set_debug_traps
10642@kindex set_debug_traps
10643@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10644This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10645program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10646beginning of your program.
10647
10648@item handle_exception
10649@kindex handle_exception
10650@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10651This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10652explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10653run when a trap is triggered.
10654
10655@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10656execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10657with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10658protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10659representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10660information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10661retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10662execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10663@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10664machine.
104c1213
JM
10665
10666@item breakpoint
10667@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10668Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10669breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10670way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10671machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10672pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10673@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10674simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10675again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10676your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10677@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10678
10679Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10680to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10681start of your debugging session.
10682@end table
10683
6d2ebf8b 10684@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10685@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10686
10687@cindex remote stub, support routines
10688The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10689chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10690debugging target machine.
10691
10692First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10693serial port.
10694
10695@table @code
10696@item int getDebugChar()
10697@kindex getDebugChar
10698Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10699It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10700different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10701
10702@item void putDebugChar(int)
10703@kindex putDebugChar
10704Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10705It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10706different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10707@end table
10708
10709@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10710@cindex interrupting remote targets
10711If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10712running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10713for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10714character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10715remote system to stop.
10716
10717Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10718probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10719is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10720@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10721
10722Other routines you need to supply are:
10723
10724@table @code
10725@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10726@kindex exceptionHandler
10727Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10728handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10729way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10730are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10731containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10732@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10733its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10734might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10735exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10736@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10737and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10738you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10739should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10740
10741For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10742gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10743should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10744@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10745help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10746
10747@item void flush_i_cache()
10748@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10749On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10750instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10751instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10752
10753On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10754function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10755@end table
10756
10757@noindent
10758You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10759
10760@table @code
10761@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10762@kindex memset
10763This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10764memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10765@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10766either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10767@end table
10768
10769If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10770library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10771but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10772subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10773
10774
6d2ebf8b 10775@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10776@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10777
10778@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10779In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10780steps.
10781
10782@enumerate
10783@item
6d2ebf8b 10784Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10785(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10786@display
10787@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10788@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10789@end display
10790
10791@item
10792Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10793
474c8240 10794@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10795set_debug_traps();
10796breakpoint();
474c8240 10797@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10798
10799@item
10800For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10801@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10802
474c8240 10803@smallexample
104c1213 10804void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10805@end smallexample
104c1213 10806
d4f3574e 10807@noindent
104c1213 10808but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10809function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10810@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10811error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10812one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10813
10814@item
10815Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10816your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10817
10818@item
10819Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10820the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10821
10822@item
10823@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10824@c document that. FIXME.
10825Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10826whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10827
10828@item
10829To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10830as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10831This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10832of its pure text.
10833
d4f3574e 10834@item
104c1213 10835@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10836Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10837Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10838machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10839TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10840to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10841device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10842
474c8240 10843@smallexample
104c1213 10844target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10845@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10846
10847@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10848To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10849@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10850For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10851terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10852
474c8240 10853@smallexample
104c1213 10854target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10855@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10856
10857If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10858your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10859the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10860to port 1234 on your local machine:
10861
474c8240 10862@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10863target remote :1234
474c8240 10864@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10865@noindent
10866
10867Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10868
10869@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10870To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10871@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10872on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10873
10874@smallexample
10875target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10876@end smallexample
10877
10878When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10879that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10880busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10881session.
10882
104c1213
JM
10883@end enumerate
10884
10885Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10886step and continue the remote program.
10887
10888To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10889command.
10890
10891@cindex interrupting remote programs
10892@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10893Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10894interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10895program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10896and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10897interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10898
474c8240 10899@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10900Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10901Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10902@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10903
10904If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10905(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10906remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10907goes back to waiting.
10908
104c1213 10909
8e04817f
AC
10910@node Configurations
10911@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10912
8e04817f
AC
10913While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10914cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10915describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10916
8e04817f
AC
10917There are three major categories of configurations: native
10918configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10919operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10920different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10921are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10922
8e04817f
AC
10923@menu
10924* Native::
10925* Embedded OS::
10926* Embedded Processors::
10927* Architectures::
10928@end menu
104c1213 10929
8e04817f
AC
10930@node Native
10931@section Native
104c1213 10932
8e04817f
AC
10933This section describes details specific to particular native
10934configurations.
6cf7e474 10935
8e04817f
AC
10936@menu
10937* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10938* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10939* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10940* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10941@end menu
6cf7e474 10942
8e04817f
AC
10943@node HP-UX
10944@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10945
8e04817f
AC
10946On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10947begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10948name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10949
8e04817f
AC
10950@node SVR4 Process Information
10951@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10952
8e04817f
AC
10953@kindex /proc
10954@cindex process image
104c1213 10955
8e04817f
AC
10956Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10957used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10958subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10959this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10960several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10961@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10962@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10963and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10964
8e04817f
AC
10965@table @code
10966@kindex info proc
10967@item info proc
10968Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10969
8e04817f
AC
10970@kindex info proc mappings
10971@item info proc mappings
10972Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10973on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10974@ignore
10975@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10976@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10977@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10978@kindex info proc times
10979@item info proc times
10980Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10981its children.
6cf7e474 10982
8e04817f
AC
10983@kindex info proc id
10984@item info proc id
10985Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10986the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10987
8e04817f
AC
10988@kindex info proc status
10989@item info proc status
10990General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10991stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10992received.
d4f3574e 10993
8e04817f
AC
10994@item info proc all
10995Show all the above information about the process.
10996@end ignore
10997@end table
104c1213 10998
8e04817f
AC
10999@node DJGPP Native
11000@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11001@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11002@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11003@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11004
8e04817f
AC
11005@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11006MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11007that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11008top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11009
8e04817f
AC
11010@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11011defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11012subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11013
8e04817f
AC
11014@table @code
11015@kindex info dos
11016@item info dos
11017This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11018information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11019
8e04817f
AC
11020@kindex sysinfo
11021@cindex MS-DOS system info
11022@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11023@item info dos sysinfo
11024This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11025platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11026DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11027
8e04817f
AC
11028@cindex GDT
11029@cindex LDT
11030@cindex IDT
11031@cindex segment descriptor tables
11032@cindex descriptor tables display
11033@item info dos gdt
11034@itemx info dos ldt
11035@itemx info dos idt
11036These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11037and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11038tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11039that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11040descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11041descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11042rights.
104c1213 11043
8e04817f
AC
11044A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11045segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11046allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11047conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11048additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11049
8e04817f
AC
11050@cindex garbled pointers
11051These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11052Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11053displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11054display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11055example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11056debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11057
8e04817f
AC
11058@smallexample
11059@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11060@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11061@end smallexample
104c1213 11062
8e04817f
AC
11063@noindent
11064This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11065the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11066
8e04817f
AC
11067@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11068@item info dos pde
11069@itemx info dos pte
11070These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11071Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11072data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11073into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11074page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11075may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11076Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11077that is currently in use.
104c1213 11078
8e04817f
AC
11079Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11080Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11081the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11082@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11083Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11084means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11085the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11086
8e04817f
AC
11087@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11088These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11089Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11090controller.
104c1213 11091
8e04817f 11092These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11093
8e04817f
AC
11094@cindex physical address from linear address
11095@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11096This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11097address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11098appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11099accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11100example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11101the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11102
8e04817f
AC
11103@smallexample
11104@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11105@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11106@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11107@end smallexample
104c1213 11108
8e04817f
AC
11109@noindent
11110This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11111whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11112attributes of that page.
104c1213 11113
8e04817f
AC
11114Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11115since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11116address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11117be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11118declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11119@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11120
8e04817f
AC
11121Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11122transfer buffer:
104c1213 11123
8e04817f
AC
11124@smallexample
11125@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11126@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11127@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11128@end smallexample
104c1213 11129
8e04817f
AC
11130@noindent
11131(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
111323rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11133this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11134mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11135
8e04817f
AC
11136This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11137@end table
104c1213 11138
78c47bea
PM
11139@node Cygwin Native
11140@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11141@cindex MS Windows debugging
11142@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11143@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11144
11145@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11146defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11147subsection describes those commands.
11148
11149@table @code
11150@kindex info w32
11151@item info w32
11152This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11153information about the target system and important OS structures.
11154
11155@item info w32 selector
11156This command displays information returned by
11157the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11158It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11159a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11160Without argument, this command displays information
11161about the the six segment registers.
11162
11163@kindex info dll
11164@item info dll
11165This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11166
11167@kindex dll-symbols
11168@item dll-symbols
11169This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11170add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11171
11172@kindex set new-console
11173@item set new-console @var{mode}
11174If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11175be started in a new console on next start.
11176If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11177be started in the same console as the debugger.
11178
11179@kindex show new-console
11180@item show new-console
11181Displays whether a new console is used
11182when the debuggee is started.
11183
11184@kindex set new-group
11185@item set new-group @var{mode}
11186This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11187start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11188This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11189Ctrl-C.
11190
11191@kindex show new-group
11192@item show new-group
11193Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11194
11195@kindex set debugevents
11196@item set debugevents
11197This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11198
11199@kindex set debugexec
11200@item set debugexec
11201This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11202seen by the debugger.
11203
11204@kindex set debugexceptions
11205@item set debugexceptions
11206This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11207seen by the debugger.
11208
11209@kindex set debugmemory
11210@item set debugmemory
11211This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11212seen by the debugger.
11213
11214@kindex set shell
11215@item set shell
11216This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11217via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11218
11219@kindex show shell
11220@item show shell
11221Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11222
11223@end table
11224
8e04817f
AC
11225@node Embedded OS
11226@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11227
8e04817f
AC
11228This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11229embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11230architectures.
d4f3574e 11231
8e04817f
AC
11232@menu
11233* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11234@end menu
104c1213 11235
8e04817f
AC
11236@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11237various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11238
8e04817f
AC
11239@node VxWorks
11240@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11241
8e04817f 11242@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11243
8e04817f 11244@table @code
104c1213 11245
8e04817f
AC
11246@kindex target vxworks
11247@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11248A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11249is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11250
8e04817f 11251@end table
104c1213 11252
8e04817f
AC
11253On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11254current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11255
8e04817f
AC
11256@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11257VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11258the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11259both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11260@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11261installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11262@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11263
8e04817f
AC
11264@table @code
11265@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11266@kindex vxworks-timeout
11267All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11268This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11269seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11270your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11271of a thin network line.
11272@end table
104c1213 11273
8e04817f
AC
11274The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11275this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11276procedures.
104c1213 11277
8e04817f
AC
11278@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11279To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11280to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11281library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11282VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11283kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11284source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11285information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11286manual.
11287@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11288
8e04817f
AC
11289Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11290your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11291run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11292@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11293
8e04817f 11294@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11295
474c8240 11296@smallexample
8e04817f 11297(vxgdb)
474c8240 11298@end smallexample
104c1213 11299
8e04817f
AC
11300@menu
11301* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11302* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11303* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11304@end menu
104c1213 11305
8e04817f
AC
11306@node VxWorks Connection
11307@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11308
8e04817f
AC
11309The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11310network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11311
474c8240 11312@smallexample
8e04817f 11313(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11314@end smallexample
104c1213 11315
8e04817f
AC
11316@need 750
11317@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11318
8e04817f
AC
11319@smallexample
11320Attaching remote machine across net...
11321Connected to tt.
11322@end smallexample
104c1213 11323
8e04817f
AC
11324@need 1000
11325@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11326loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11327these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11328path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11329to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11330
474c8240 11331@smallexample
8e04817f 11332prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11333@end smallexample
104c1213 11334
8e04817f
AC
11335When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11336the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11337command again.
104c1213 11338
8e04817f
AC
11339@node VxWorks Download
11340@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11341
8e04817f
AC
11342@cindex download to VxWorks
11343If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11344object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11345@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11346incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11347command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11348to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11349table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11350the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11351filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11352Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11353to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11354the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11355@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11356and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11357program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11358
474c8240 11359@smallexample
8e04817f 11360-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11361@end smallexample
104c1213 11362
8e04817f
AC
11363@noindent
11364Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11365
474c8240 11366@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11367(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11368(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11369@end smallexample
104c1213 11370
8e04817f 11371@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11372
8e04817f
AC
11373@smallexample
11374Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11375@end smallexample
104c1213 11376
8e04817f
AC
11377You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11378after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11379this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11380auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11381history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11382debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11383table.)
104c1213 11384
8e04817f
AC
11385@node VxWorks Attach
11386@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11387
11388@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11389You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11390follows:
11391
474c8240 11392@smallexample
104c1213 11393(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11394@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11395
11396@noindent
11397where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11398or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11399the time of attachment.
11400
6d2ebf8b 11401@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11402@section Embedded Processors
11403
11404This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11405configurations.
11406
7d86b5d5 11407
104c1213 11408@menu
104c1213
JM
11409* ARM:: ARM
11410* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11411* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
104c1213
JM
11412* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11413* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11414* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11415* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11416* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11417* PowerPC: PowerPC
11418* SH:: Hitachi SH
11419* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11420* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11421* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11422* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11423@end menu
11424
6d2ebf8b 11425@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11426@subsection ARM
11427
11428@table @code
11429
8e04817f
AC
11430@kindex target rdi
11431@item target rdi @var{dev}
11432ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11433use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11434monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11435
11436@kindex target rdp
11437@item target rdp @var{dev}
11438ARM Demon monitor.
11439
11440@end table
11441
11442@node H8/300
11443@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11444
11445@table @code
11446
11447@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11448@item target hms @var{dev}
11449A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11450Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11451line and the communications speed used.
11452
11453@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11454@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11455E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11456
11457@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11458@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11459@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11460@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11461Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11462
11463@end table
11464
11465@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11466@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11467@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11468@cindex Hitachi SH download
11469When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11470board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11471board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11472@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11473
11474@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11475Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11476
11477@enumerate
11478@item
11479that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11480for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11481emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11482the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11483H8/300, or H8/500.)
11484
11485@item
11486what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11487serial device available on your host is the default).
11488
11489@item
11490what speed to use over the serial device.
11491@end enumerate
11492
11493@menu
11494* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11495* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11496* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11497@end menu
11498
11499@node Hitachi Boards
11500@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11501
11502@c only for Unix hosts
11503@kindex device
11504@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11505Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11506need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11507first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11508hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11509
11510@kindex speed
11511@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11512@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11513speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11514hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11515the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11516@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11517
11518The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11519use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11520use a DOS host,
11521@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11522called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11523through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11524to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11525
11526The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11527program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11528sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11529the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11530
11531First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11532board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11533port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11534When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11535debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11536for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11537@code{COM2}.
11538
474c8240 11539@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11540C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11541C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11542
11543Resident portion of MODE loaded
11544
11545COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11546
474c8240 11547@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11548
11549@quotation
11550@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11551@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11552disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11553your development board.
11554@end quotation
11555
11556@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11557Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11558connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11559the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11560you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11561commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11562cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11563download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11564the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11565(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11566executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11567@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11568itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11569
11570@smallexample
11571(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11572@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11573 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11574 the conditions.
11575There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11576for details.
11577@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11578(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11579Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11580(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11581.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11582.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11583.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11584@end smallexample
11585
11586At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11587you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11588sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11589@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11590resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11591@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11592
11593Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11594available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11595you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11596
11597Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11598@itemize @bullet
11599@item
11600to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11601no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11602
11603@item
11604to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11605normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11606to detect program completion.
11607@end itemize
11608
11609In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11610development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11611
11612@node Hitachi ICE
11613@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11614
11615@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11616You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11617Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11618e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11619
11620@table @code
11621@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11622Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11623@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11624@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11625(for example, @samp{9600}).
11626
11627@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11628If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11629specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11630@end table
11631
11632@node Hitachi Special
11633@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11634
11635Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11636
11637@table @code
11638
11639@kindex set machine
11640@kindex show machine
11641@item set machine h8300
11642@itemx set machine h8300h
11643Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11644architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11645to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11646
11647@end table
11648
8e04817f
AC
11649@node H8/500
11650@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11651
11652@table @code
11653
8e04817f
AC
11654@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11655@cindex memory models, H8/500
11656@item set memory @var{mod}
11657@itemx show memory
11658Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11659@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11660memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11661@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11662
8e04817f 11663@end table
104c1213 11664
8e04817f
AC
11665@node M32R/D
11666@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11667
11668@table @code
11669
11670@kindex target m32r
11671@item target m32r @var{dev}
11672Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11673
11674@end table
11675
11676@node M68K
11677@subsection M68k
11678
11679The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11680target command for the following ROM monitors.
11681
11682@table @code
11683
11684@kindex target abug
11685@item target abug @var{dev}
11686ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11687
11688@kindex target cpu32bug
11689@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11690CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11691
11692@kindex target dbug
11693@item target dbug @var{dev}
11694dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11695
11696@kindex target est
11697@item target est @var{dev}
11698EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11699
11700@kindex target rom68k
11701@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11702ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11703
11704@end table
11705
8e04817f
AC
11706@table @code
11707
11708@kindex target rombug
11709@item target rombug @var{dev}
11710ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11711
11712@end table
11713
8e04817f
AC
11714@node MIPS Embedded
11715@subsection MIPS Embedded
11716
11717@cindex MIPS boards
11718@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11719MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11720you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11721
8e04817f
AC
11722@need 1000
11723Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11724
8e04817f
AC
11725@table @code
11726@item target mips @var{port}
11727@kindex target mips @var{port}
11728To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11729name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11730command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11731the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11732been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11733download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11734
8e04817f
AC
11735For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11736port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11737debugger:
104c1213 11738
474c8240 11739@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11740host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11741@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11742(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11743(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11744(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11745@end smallexample
104c1213 11746
8e04817f
AC
11747@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11748On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11749connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11750concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11751@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11752
8e04817f
AC
11753@item target pmon @var{port}
11754@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11755PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11756
8e04817f
AC
11757@item target ddb @var{port}
11758@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11759NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11760
8e04817f
AC
11761@item target lsi @var{port}
11762@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11763LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11764
8e04817f
AC
11765@kindex target r3900
11766@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11767Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11768
8e04817f
AC
11769@kindex target array
11770@item target array @var{dev}
11771Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11772
8e04817f 11773@end table
104c1213 11774
104c1213 11775
8e04817f
AC
11776@noindent
11777@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11778
8e04817f
AC
11779@table @code
11780@item set processor @var{args}
11781@itemx show processor
11782@kindex set processor @var{args}
11783@kindex show processor
11784Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11785processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11786For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11787to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11788Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11789is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11790@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11791
8e04817f
AC
11792@item set mipsfpu double
11793@itemx set mipsfpu single
11794@itemx set mipsfpu none
11795@itemx show mipsfpu
11796@kindex set mipsfpu
11797@kindex show mipsfpu
11798@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11799@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11800If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11801coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11802need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11803file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11804functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11805@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11806functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11807with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11808processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11809double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11810@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11811
8e04817f
AC
11812In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11813floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11814and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11815
8e04817f
AC
11816As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11817@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11818
8e04817f
AC
11819@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11820@itemx show remotedebug
11821@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11822@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11823@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11824@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11825@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11826@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11827You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11828by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11829@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11830to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11831at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11832
8e04817f
AC
11833@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11834@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11835@itemx show timeout
11836@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11837@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11838@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11839@kindex set timeout
11840@kindex show timeout
11841@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11842@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11843You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11844remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11845default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11846waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11847retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11848You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11849retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11850@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11851
8e04817f
AC
11852The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11853is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11854forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11855to run before stopping.
11856@end table
104c1213 11857
a37295f9
MM
11858@node OpenRISC 1000
11859@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11860@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11861
11862@cindex or1k boards
11863See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11864about platform and commands.
11865
11866@table @code
11867
11868@kindex target jtag
11869@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11870
11871Connects to remote JTAG server.
11872JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11873connected via parallel port to the board.
11874
11875Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11876
11877@kindex or1ksim
11878@item or1ksim @var{command}
11879If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11880Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11881
11882@kindex info or1k spr
11883@item info or1k spr
11884Displays spr groups.
11885
11886@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11887@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11888Displays register names in selected group.
11889
11890@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11891@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11892@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11893@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11894Shows information about specified spr register.
11895
11896@kindex spr
11897@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11898@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11899@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11900@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11901Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11902@end table
11903
11904Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11905It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11906program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11907triggers can be set using:
11908@table @code
11909@item $LEA/$LDATA
11910Load effective address/data
11911@item $SEA/$SDATA
11912Store effective address/data
11913@item $AEA/$ADATA
11914Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11915@item $FETCH
11916Fetch data
11917@end table
11918
11919When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11920@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11921
11922@code{htrace} commands:
11923@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11924@table @code
11925@kindex hwatch
11926@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11927Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11928or Data. For example:
11929
11930@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11931
11932@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11933
11934@kindex htrace info
11935@item htrace info
11936Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11937
11938@kindex htrace trigger
11939@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11940Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11941
11942@kindex htrace qualifier
11943@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11944Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11945
11946@kindex htrace stop
11947@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11948Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11949
11950@kindex htrace record
f153cc92 11951@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
a37295f9
MM
11952Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11953triggered.
11954
11955@kindex htrace enable
11956@item htrace enable
11957@kindex htrace disable
11958@itemx htrace disable
11959Enables/disables the HW trace.
11960
11961@kindex htrace rewind
f153cc92 11962@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
a37295f9
MM
11963Clears currently recorded trace data.
11964
11965If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11966will be written there.
11967
11968@kindex htrace print
f153cc92 11969@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
a37295f9
MM
11970Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11971
11972@kindex htrace mode continuous
11973@item htrace mode continuous
11974Set continuous trace mode.
11975
11976@kindex htrace mode suspend
11977@item htrace mode suspend
11978Set suspend trace mode.
11979
11980@end table
11981
8e04817f
AC
11982@node PowerPC
11983@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11984
11985@table @code
104c1213 11986
8e04817f
AC
11987@kindex target dink32
11988@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11989DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11990
8e04817f
AC
11991@kindex target ppcbug
11992@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11993@kindex target ppcbug1
11994@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11995PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11996
8e04817f
AC
11997@kindex target sds
11998@item target sds @var{dev}
11999SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12000
12001@end table
12002
12003@node PA
12004@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12005
12006@table @code
12007
8e04817f
AC
12008@kindex target op50n
12009@item target op50n @var{dev}
12010OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12011
12012@kindex target w89k
12013@item target w89k @var{dev}
12014W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12015
12016@end table
12017
8e04817f
AC
12018@node SH
12019@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12020
12021@table @code
12022
8e04817f
AC
12023@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12024@item target hms @var{dev}
12025A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12026commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12027the communications speed used.
104c1213 12028
8e04817f
AC
12029@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12030@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12031E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12032
8e04817f
AC
12033@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12034@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12035@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12036@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12037Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12038
8e04817f 12039@end table
104c1213 12040
8e04817f
AC
12041@node Sparclet
12042@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12043
8e04817f
AC
12044@cindex Sparclet
12045
12046@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12047Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12048@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12049both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12050@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12051
8e04817f
AC
12052@table @code
12053@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12054@kindex remotetimeout
12055@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12056This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12057seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12058@end table
12059
8e04817f
AC
12060@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12061When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12062information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12063load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12064@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12065
474c8240 12066@smallexample
8e04817f 12067sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12068@end smallexample
104c1213 12069
8e04817f 12070You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12071
474c8240 12072@smallexample
8e04817f 12073sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12074@end smallexample
104c1213 12075
8e04817f
AC
12076@cindex running, on Sparclet
12077Once you have set
12078your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12079run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12080(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12081
8e04817f
AC
12082@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12083
474c8240 12084@smallexample
8e04817f 12085(gdbslet)
474c8240 12086@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12087
12088@menu
8e04817f
AC
12089* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12090* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12091* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12092* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12093@end menu
12094
8e04817f
AC
12095@node Sparclet File
12096@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12097
8e04817f 12098The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12099
474c8240 12100@smallexample
8e04817f 12101(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12102@end smallexample
104c1213 12103
8e04817f
AC
12104@need 1000
12105@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12106@value{GDBN} locates
12107the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12108path.
12109If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12110files will be searched as well.
12111@value{GDBN} locates
12112the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12113path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12114If it fails
12115to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12116
474c8240 12117@smallexample
8e04817f 12118prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12119@end smallexample
104c1213 12120
8e04817f
AC
12121When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12122the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12123@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12124
8e04817f
AC
12125@node Sparclet Connection
12126@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12127
8e04817f
AC
12128The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12129To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12130
474c8240 12131@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12132(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12133Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12134main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12135@end smallexample
104c1213 12136
8e04817f
AC
12137@need 750
12138@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12139
474c8240 12140@smallexample
8e04817f 12141Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12142@end smallexample
104c1213 12143
8e04817f
AC
12144@node Sparclet Download
12145@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12146
8e04817f
AC
12147@cindex download to Sparclet
12148Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12149you can use the @value{GDBN}
12150@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12151The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12152command.
12153Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12154address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12155offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12156of each of the file's sections.
12157For instance, if the program
12158@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12159and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12160
474c8240 12161@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12162(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12163Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12164@end smallexample
104c1213 12165
8e04817f
AC
12166If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12167to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12168to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12169
12170@node Sparclet Execution
12171@subsubsection Running and debugging
12172
12173@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12174You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12175commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12176manual for the list of commands.
12177
474c8240 12178@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12179(gdbslet) b main
12180Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12181(gdbslet) run
12182Starting program: prog
12183Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121843 char *symarg = 0;
12185(gdbslet) step
121864 char *execarg = "hello!";
12187(gdbslet)
474c8240 12188@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12189
12190@node Sparclite
12191@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12192
12193@table @code
12194
8e04817f
AC
12195@kindex target sparclite
12196@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12197Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12198You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12199For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12200remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12201
12202@end table
12203
8e04817f
AC
12204@node ST2000
12205@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12206
8e04817f
AC
12207@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12208STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12209
8e04817f
AC
12210To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12211manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12212
474c8240 12213@smallexample
8e04817f 12214target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12215@end smallexample
104c1213 12216
8e04817f
AC
12217@noindent
12218to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12219the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12220ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12221connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12222concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12223
8e04817f
AC
12224The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12225this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12226would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12227(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12228available on your host computer.
12229@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12230@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12231
8e04817f
AC
12232@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12233These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12234environment:
104c1213 12235
8e04817f
AC
12236@table @code
12237@item st2000 @var{command}
12238@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12239@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12240@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12241Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12242manual for available commands.
104c1213 12243
8e04817f
AC
12244@item connect
12245@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12246Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12247you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12248sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12249@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12250@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12251@end table
12252
8e04817f
AC
12253@node Z8000
12254@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12255
8e04817f
AC
12256@cindex Z8000
12257@cindex simulator, Z8000
12258@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12259
8e04817f
AC
12260When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12261a Z8000 simulator.
12262
12263For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12264unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12265segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12266appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12267
8e04817f
AC
12268@table @code
12269@item target sim @var{args}
12270@kindex sim
12271@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12272Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12273options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12274@end table
12275
8e04817f
AC
12276@noindent
12277After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12278CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12279@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12280to run your program, and so on.
12281
12282As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12283(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12284additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12285
12286@table @code
12287
8e04817f
AC
12288@item cycles
12289Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12290
8e04817f
AC
12291@item insts
12292Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12293
8e04817f
AC
12294@item time
12295Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12296
8e04817f 12297@end table
104c1213 12298
8e04817f
AC
12299You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12300conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12301conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12302simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12303
8e04817f
AC
12304@node Architectures
12305@section Architectures
104c1213 12306
8e04817f
AC
12307This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12308all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12309
8e04817f
AC
12310@menu
12311* A29K::
12312* Alpha::
12313* MIPS::
12314@end menu
104c1213 12315
8e04817f
AC
12316@node A29K
12317@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12318
12319@table @code
104c1213 12320
8e04817f
AC
12321@kindex set rstack_high_address
12322@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12323@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12324@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12325On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12326@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12327extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12328stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12329memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12330this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12331the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12332address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12333hexadecimal.
104c1213 12334
8e04817f
AC
12335@kindex show rstack_high_address
12336@item show rstack_high_address
12337Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12338processors.
104c1213 12339
8e04817f 12340@end table
104c1213 12341
8e04817f
AC
12342@node Alpha
12343@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12344
8e04817f 12345See the following section.
104c1213 12346
8e04817f
AC
12347@node MIPS
12348@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12349
8e04817f
AC
12350@cindex stack on Alpha
12351@cindex stack on MIPS
12352@cindex Alpha stack
12353@cindex MIPS stack
12354Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12355sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12356find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12357
8e04817f
AC
12358@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12359To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12360@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12361you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12362commands:
104c1213 12363
8e04817f
AC
12364@table @code
12365@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12366@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12367Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12368search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12369default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12370larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12371and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@item show heuristic-fence-post
12374Display the current limit.
12375@end table
104c1213
JM
12376
12377@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12378These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12379for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12380
104c1213 12381
8e04817f
AC
12382@node Controlling GDB
12383@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12384
12385You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12386@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12387data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12388described here.
12389
12390@menu
12391* Prompt:: Prompt
12392* Editing:: Command editing
12393* History:: Command history
12394* Screen Size:: Screen size
12395* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12396* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12397* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12398* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12399@end menu
12400
12401@node Prompt
12402@section Prompt
104c1213 12403
8e04817f 12404@cindex prompt
104c1213 12405
8e04817f
AC
12406@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12407called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12408can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12409instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12410the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12411which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12412
8e04817f
AC
12413@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12414prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12415or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12416
8e04817f
AC
12417@table @code
12418@kindex set prompt
12419@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12420Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12421
8e04817f
AC
12422@kindex show prompt
12423@item show prompt
12424Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12425@end table
12426
8e04817f
AC
12427@node Editing
12428@section Command editing
12429@cindex readline
12430@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12431
8e04817f
AC
12432@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12433@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12434command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12435or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12436substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12437debugging sessions.
104c1213 12438
8e04817f
AC
12439You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12440command @code{set}.
104c1213 12441
8e04817f
AC
12442@table @code
12443@kindex set editing
12444@cindex editing
12445@item set editing
12446@itemx set editing on
12447Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12448
8e04817f
AC
12449@item set editing off
12450Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12451
8e04817f
AC
12452@kindex show editing
12453@item show editing
12454Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12455@end table
12456
8e04817f
AC
12457@node History
12458@section Command history
12459
12460@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12461debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12462happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12463history facility.
104c1213
JM
12464
12465@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12466@cindex history substitution
12467@cindex history file
12468@kindex set history filename
12469@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12470@item set history filename @var{fname}
12471Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12472This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12473list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12474exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12475the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12476to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12477@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12478is not set.
104c1213 12479
8e04817f
AC
12480@cindex history save
12481@kindex set history save
12482@item set history save
12483@itemx set history save on
12484Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12485@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12486
8e04817f
AC
12487@item set history save off
12488Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12489
8e04817f
AC
12490@cindex history size
12491@kindex set history size
12492@item set history size @var{size}
12493Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12494This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12495@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12496@end table
12497
8e04817f
AC
12498@cindex history expansion
12499History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12500@ifset have-readline-appendices
12501@xref{Event Designators}.
12502@end ifset
12503
12504Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12505is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12506@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12507follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12508a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12509history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12510@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12511
12512The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12513
12514@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12515@kindex set history expansion
12516@item set history expansion on
12517@itemx set history expansion
12518Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12519
8e04817f
AC
12520@item set history expansion off
12521Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12522
8e04817f
AC
12523The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12524editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12525or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12526@ifset have-readline-appendices
12527@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12528@end ifset
104c1213 12529
8e04817f
AC
12530@c @group
12531@kindex show history
12532@item show history
12533@itemx show history filename
12534@itemx show history save
12535@itemx show history size
12536@itemx show history expansion
12537These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12538@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12539@c @end group
12540@end table
12541
12542@table @code
12543@kindex shows
12544@item show commands
12545Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12546
8e04817f
AC
12547@item show commands @var{n}
12548Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12549
12550@item show commands +
12551Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12552@end table
12553
8e04817f
AC
12554@node Screen Size
12555@section Screen size
12556@cindex size of screen
12557@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12558
8e04817f
AC
12559Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12560information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12561@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12562output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12563to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12564determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12565printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12566rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12567
12568Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12569driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12570together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12571@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12572you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12573width} commands:
12574
12575@table @code
12576@kindex set height
12577@kindex set width
12578@kindex show width
12579@kindex show height
12580@item set height @var{lpp}
12581@itemx show height
12582@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12583@itemx show width
12584These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12585a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12586commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12587
8e04817f
AC
12588If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12589output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12590file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12591
8e04817f
AC
12592Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12593from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12594@end table
12595
8e04817f
AC
12596@node Numbers
12597@section Numbers
12598@cindex number representation
12599@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12600
8e04817f
AC
12601You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12602@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12603@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12604begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12605default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12606numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12607change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12608radix} command.
104c1213 12609
8e04817f
AC
12610@table @code
12611@kindex set input-radix
12612@item set input-radix @var{base}
12613Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12614for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12615specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12616example, any of
104c1213 12617
8e04817f
AC
12618@smallexample
12619set radix 012
12620set radix 10.
12621set radix 0xa
12622@end smallexample
104c1213 12623
8e04817f
AC
12624@noindent
12625sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12626leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12627
8e04817f
AC
12628@kindex set output-radix
12629@item set output-radix @var{base}
12630Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12631for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12632specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12633
8e04817f
AC
12634@kindex show input-radix
12635@item show input-radix
12636Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12637
8e04817f
AC
12638@kindex show output-radix
12639@item show output-radix
12640Display the current default base for numeric display.
12641@end table
104c1213 12642
1e698235
DJ
12643@node ABI
12644@section Configuring the current ABI
12645
12646@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12647application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12648conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12649current ABI.
12650
98b45e30
DJ
12651@cindex OS ABI
12652@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12653@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12654
12655One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12656system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12657@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12658but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12659One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12660an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12661not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12662platform provides.
12663
12664@table @code
12665@item show osabi
12666Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12667
12668@item set osabi
12669With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12670
12671@item set osabi @var{abi}
12672Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12673@end table
12674
1e698235
DJ
12675@cindex float promotion
12676@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12677
12678Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12679function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12680(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12681according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12682(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12683@code{double} and then passed.
12684
12685Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12686a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12687as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12688
12689@table @code
12690@item set coerce-float-to-double
12691@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12692Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12693to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12694
12695@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12696Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12697functions.
12698@end table
12699
8e04817f
AC
12700@node Messages/Warnings
12701@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12702
8e04817f
AC
12703By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12704running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12705command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12706internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12707
8e04817f
AC
12708Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12709which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12710see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12711
8e04817f
AC
12712@table @code
12713@kindex set verbose
12714@item set verbose on
12715Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12716
8e04817f
AC
12717@item set verbose off
12718Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12719
8e04817f
AC
12720@kindex show verbose
12721@item show verbose
12722Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12723@end table
104c1213 12724
8e04817f
AC
12725By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12726object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12727find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12728symbol files}).
104c1213 12729
8e04817f 12730@table @code
104c1213 12731
8e04817f
AC
12732@kindex set complaints
12733@item set complaints @var{limit}
12734Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12735unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12736@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12737to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12738
8e04817f
AC
12739@kindex show complaints
12740@item show complaints
12741Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12742
8e04817f 12743@end table
104c1213 12744
8e04817f
AC
12745By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12746lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12747you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12748
474c8240 12749@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12750(@value{GDBP}) run
12751The program being debugged has been started already.
12752Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12753@end smallexample
104c1213 12754
8e04817f
AC
12755If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12756commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12757
8e04817f 12758@table @code
104c1213 12759
8e04817f
AC
12760@kindex set confirm
12761@cindex flinching
12762@cindex confirmation
12763@cindex stupid questions
12764@item set confirm off
12765Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12766
8e04817f
AC
12767@item set confirm on
12768Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12769
8e04817f
AC
12770@kindex show confirm
12771@item show confirm
12772Displays state of confirmation requests.
12773
12774@end table
104c1213 12775
8e04817f
AC
12776@node Debugging Output
12777@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12778@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12779@kindex set debug arch
12780@item set debug arch
12781Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12782@kindex show debug arch
12783@item show debug arch
12784Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12785@kindex set debug event
12786@item set debug event
12787Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12788default is off.
12789@kindex show debug event
12790@item show debug event
12791Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12792info.
12793@kindex set debug expression
12794@item set debug expression
12795Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12796default is off.
12797@kindex show debug expression
12798@item show debug expression
12799Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12800debugging info.
12801@kindex set debug overload
12802@item set debug overload
12803Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12804info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12805is off.
12806@kindex show debug overload
12807@item show debug overload
12808Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12809debugging info.
12810@kindex set debug remote
12811@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12812@cindex serial connections, debugging
12813@item set debug remote
12814Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12815the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12816@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12817@kindex show debug remote
12818@item show debug remote
12819Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12820@kindex set debug serial
12821@item set debug serial
12822Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12823default is off.
12824@kindex show debug serial
12825@item show debug serial
12826Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12827info.
12828@kindex set debug target
12829@item set debug target
12830Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12831includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12832default is off.
12833@kindex show debug target
12834@item show debug target
12835Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12836info.
12837@kindex set debug varobj
12838@item set debug varobj
12839Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12840info. The default is off.
12841@kindex show debug varobj
12842@item show debug varobj
12843Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12844debugging info.
12845@end table
104c1213 12846
8e04817f
AC
12847@node Sequences
12848@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12849
8e04817f
AC
12850Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12851command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12852commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12853files.
104c1213 12854
8e04817f
AC
12855@menu
12856* Define:: User-defined commands
12857* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12858* Command Files:: Command files
12859* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12860@end menu
104c1213 12861
8e04817f
AC
12862@node Define
12863@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12864
8e04817f
AC
12865@cindex user-defined command
12866A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12867which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12868@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12869separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12870via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12871
8e04817f
AC
12872@smallexample
12873define adder
12874 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12875@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12876
12877@noindent
8e04817f 12878To execute the command use:
104c1213 12879
8e04817f
AC
12880@smallexample
12881adder 1 2 3
12882@end smallexample
104c1213 12883
8e04817f
AC
12884@noindent
12885This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12886its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12887reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12888functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12889
12890@table @code
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892@kindex define
12893@item define @var{commandname}
12894Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12895by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12896
8e04817f
AC
12897The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12898which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12899commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12900
8e04817f
AC
12901@kindex if
12902@kindex else
12903@item if
12904Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12905It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12906only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12907There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12908by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12909was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12910
8e04817f
AC
12911@kindex while
12912@item while
12913The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12914which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12915execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12916The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12917evaluates to true.
104c1213 12918
8e04817f
AC
12919@kindex document
12920@item document @var{commandname}
12921Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12922accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12923defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12924reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12925After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12926@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12927
8e04817f
AC
12928You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12929documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12930does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12931
8e04817f
AC
12932@kindex help user-defined
12933@item help user-defined
12934List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12935(if any) for each.
104c1213 12936
8e04817f
AC
12937@kindex show user
12938@item show user
12939@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12940Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12941not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12942definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12943
20f01a46
DH
12944@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12945@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12946@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12947@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12948The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12949levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12950infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12951
104c1213
JM
12952@end table
12953
8e04817f
AC
12954When user-defined commands are executed, the
12955commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12956stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12957
8e04817f
AC
12958If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12959without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12960commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12961messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12962
8e04817f
AC
12963@node Hooks
12964@section User-defined command hooks
12965@cindex command hooks
12966@cindex hooks, for commands
12967@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12968
8e04817f
AC
12969@kindex hook
12970@kindex hook-
12971You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12972command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12973command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12974before that command.
104c1213 12975
8e04817f
AC
12976@cindex hooks, post-command
12977@kindex hookpost
12978@kindex hookpost-
12979A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12980Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12981@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12982that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12983pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12984
8e04817f
AC
12985It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12986occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12987
8e04817f
AC
12988@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12989@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12990
8e04817f
AC
12991@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12992In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12993(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12994execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12995displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12996
8e04817f
AC
12997For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12998single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12999you could define:
104c1213 13000
474c8240 13001@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13002define hook-stop
13003handle SIGALRM nopass
13004end
104c1213 13005
8e04817f
AC
13006define hook-run
13007handle SIGALRM pass
13008end
104c1213 13009
8e04817f
AC
13010define hook-continue
13011handle SIGLARM pass
13012end
474c8240 13013@end smallexample
104c1213 13014
8e04817f
AC
13015As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13016command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13017you could define:
104c1213 13018
474c8240 13019@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13020define hook-echo
13021echo <<<---
13022end
104c1213 13023
8e04817f
AC
13024define hookpost-echo
13025echo --->>>\n
13026end
104c1213 13027
8e04817f
AC
13028(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13029<<<---Hello World--->>>
13030(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13031
474c8240 13032@end smallexample
104c1213 13033
8e04817f
AC
13034You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13035not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13036name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13037@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13038@c or not?
13039If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13040@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13041(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13042
8e04817f
AC
13043If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13044get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13045
8e04817f
AC
13046@node Command Files
13047@section Command files
c906108c 13048
8e04817f
AC
13049@cindex command files
13050A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13051commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13052An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13053the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13054
8e04817f
AC
13055@cindex init file
13056@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13057@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13058When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13059@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13060port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13061limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13062During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13063
8e04817f
AC
13064@enumerate
13065@item
13066Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13067DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13068@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13069
8e04817f
AC
13070@item
13071Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13072
8e04817f
AC
13073@item
13074Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13075
8e04817f
AC
13076@item
13077Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13078@end enumerate
c906108c 13079
8e04817f
AC
13080The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13081complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13082and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13083option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13084
8e04817f
AC
13085@cindex init file name
13086On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13087different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13088form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13089different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13090environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13091
8e04817f
AC
13092@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13093@itemize @bullet
13094@item
13095VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13096
8e04817f
AC
13097@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13098@item
13099OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13100
8e04817f
AC
13101@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13102@item
13103ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13104@end itemize
c906108c 13105
8e04817f
AC
13106You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13107@code{source} command:
c906108c 13108
8e04817f
AC
13109@table @code
13110@kindex source
13111@item source @var{filename}
13112Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13113@end table
13114
8e04817f 13115The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13116printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13117execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13118
8e04817f
AC
13119Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13120without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13121normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13122when called from command files.
c906108c 13123
8e04817f
AC
13124@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13125mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13126standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13127not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13128the next command.
c906108c 13129
474c8240 13130@smallexample
8e04817f 13131gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13132@end smallexample
c906108c 13133
8e04817f
AC
13134(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13135will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13136would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138@node Output
13139@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13140
8e04817f
AC
13141During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13142@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13143explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13144describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13145want.
c906108c
SS
13146
13147@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13148@kindex echo
13149@item echo @var{text}
13150@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13151@c because it is not in ANSI.
13152Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13153@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13154newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13155In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13156by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13157string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13158trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13159To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13160@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13161
8e04817f
AC
13162A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13163the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13164
474c8240 13165@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13166echo This is some text\n\
13167which is continued\n\
13168onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13169@end smallexample
c906108c 13170
8e04817f 13171produces the same output as
c906108c 13172
474c8240 13173@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13174echo This is some text\n
13175echo which is continued\n
13176echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13177@end smallexample
c906108c 13178
8e04817f
AC
13179@kindex output
13180@item output @var{expression}
13181Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13182newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13183value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13184on expressions.
c906108c 13185
8e04817f
AC
13186@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13187Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13188the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13189formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13190
8e04817f
AC
13191@kindex printf
13192@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13193Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13194@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13195either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13196@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13197subroutine
13198@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13199@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13200@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13201@c supported.
c906108c 13202
474c8240 13203@smallexample
8e04817f 13204printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13205@end smallexample
c906108c 13206
8e04817f 13207For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13208
8e04817f
AC
13209@smallexample
13210printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13211@end smallexample
c906108c 13212
8e04817f
AC
13213The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13214string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13215letter.
c906108c
SS
13216@end table
13217
21c294e6
AC
13218@node Interpreters
13219@chapter Command Interpreters
13220@cindex command interpreters
13221
13222@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13223infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13224between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13225
13226@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13227interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13228and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13229describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13230
13231By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13232However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13233interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13234startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13235
13236@table @code
13237@item console
13238@cindex console interpreter
13239The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13240used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13241@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13242
13243@item mi
13244@cindex mi interpreter
13245The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13246by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13247or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13248Interface}.
13249
13250@item mi2
13251@cindex mi2 interpreter
13252The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13253
13254@item mi1
13255@cindex mi1 interpreter
13256The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13257
13258@end table
13259
13260@cindex invoke another interpreter
13261The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13262switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13263precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13264enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13265@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13266the IDE inoperable!
13267
13268@kindex interpreter-exec
13269Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13270commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13271command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13272@code{interpreter-exec} command:
13273
13274@smallexample
13275interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13276@end smallexample
13277
13278@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13279@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13280
8e04817f
AC
13281@node TUI
13282@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13283@cindex TUI
c906108c 13284
8e04817f
AC
13285@menu
13286* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13287* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13288* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13289* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13290* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13291@end menu
c906108c 13292
8e04817f
AC
13293The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13294is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13295to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13296and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13297The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13298with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13299
8e04817f
AC
13300@node TUI Overview
13301@section TUI overview
c906108c 13302
8e04817f
AC
13303The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13304@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13305
8e04817f
AC
13306@itemize @bullet
13307@item
13308A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13309windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13310
8e04817f
AC
13311@item
13312A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13313the TUI.
13314@end itemize
c906108c 13315
8e04817f
AC
13316In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13317on the terminal:
c906108c 13318
8e04817f
AC
13319@table @emph
13320@item command
13321This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13322prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13323managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13324window is always visible.
c906108c 13325
8e04817f
AC
13326@item source
13327The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13328line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13329
8e04817f
AC
13330@item assembly
13331The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13332
8e04817f
AC
13333@item register
13334This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13335a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13336changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13337
c906108c
SS
13338@end table
13339
269c21fe
SC
13340The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13341by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13342Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13343indicates the breakpoint type:
13344
13345@table @code
13346@item B
13347Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13348
13349@item b
13350Breakpoint which was never hit.
13351
13352@item H
13353Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13354
13355@item h
13356Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13357
13358@end table
13359
13360The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13361
13362@table @code
13363@item +
13364Breakpoint is enabled.
13365
13366@item -
13367Breakpoint is disabled.
13368
13369@end table
13370
8e04817f
AC
13371The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13372and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13373changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13374These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13375layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13376The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13377
8e04817f
AC
13378@itemize @bullet
13379@item
13380source
2df3850c 13381
8e04817f
AC
13382@item
13383assembly
13384
13385@item
13386source and assembly
13387
13388@item
13389source and registers
c906108c 13390
8e04817f
AC
13391@item
13392assembly and registers
2df3850c 13393
8e04817f 13394@end itemize
c906108c 13395
b7bb15bc
SC
13396On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13397concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13398updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13399are displayed:
13400
13401@table @emph
13402@item target
13403Indicates the current gdb target
13404(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13405
13406@item process
13407Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13408When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13409
13410@item function
13411Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13412The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13413When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13414the string @code{??} is displayed.
13415
13416@item line
13417Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13418When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13419
13420@item pc
13421Indicates the current program counter address.
13422
13423@end table
13424
8e04817f
AC
13425@node TUI Keys
13426@section TUI Key Bindings
13427@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13428
8e04817f
AC
13429The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13430(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13431They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13432directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13433a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13434@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13435are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13436
8e04817f
AC
13437@table @kbd
13438@kindex C-x C-a
13439@item C-x C-a
13440@kindex C-x a
13441@itemx C-x a
13442@kindex C-x A
13443@itemx C-x A
13444Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13445the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13446its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13447mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13448The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13449
8e04817f
AC
13450@kindex C-x 1
13451@item C-x 1
13452Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13453either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13454is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13455
8e04817f 13456Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13457
8e04817f
AC
13458@kindex C-x 2
13459@item C-x 2
13460Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13461layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13462When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13463previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13464
8e04817f 13465Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13466
7cf36c78
SC
13467@kindex C-x s
13468@item C-x s
13469Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13470(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13471
c906108c
SS
13472@end table
13473
8e04817f 13474The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13475
8e04817f
AC
13476@table @key
13477@kindex PgUp
13478@item PgUp
13479Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13480
8e04817f
AC
13481@kindex PgDn
13482@item PgDn
13483Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13484
8e04817f
AC
13485@kindex Up
13486@item Up
13487Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13488
8e04817f
AC
13489@kindex Down
13490@item Down
13491Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13492
8e04817f
AC
13493@kindex Left
13494@item Left
13495Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13496
8e04817f
AC
13497@kindex Right
13498@item Right
13499Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13500
8e04817f
AC
13501@kindex C-L
13502@item C-L
13503Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13504
8e04817f 13505@end table
c906108c 13506
8e04817f
AC
13507In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13508for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13509necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13510@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13511
7cf36c78
SC
13512@node TUI Single Key Mode
13513@section TUI Single Key Mode
13514@cindex TUI single key mode
13515
13516The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13517key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13518some gdb commands.
13519
13520@table @kbd
13521@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13522@item c
13523continue
13524
13525@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13526@item d
13527down
13528
13529@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13530@item f
13531finish
13532
13533@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13534@item n
13535next
13536
13537@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13538@item q
13539exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13540
13541@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13542@item r
13543run
13544
13545@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13546@item s
13547step
13548
13549@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13550@item u
13551up
13552
13553@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13554@item v
13555info locals
13556
13557@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13558@item w
13559where
13560
13561@end table
13562
13563Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13564The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13565it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13566with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13567@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13568this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13569
13570
8e04817f
AC
13571@node TUI Commands
13572@section TUI specific commands
13573@cindex TUI commands
13574
13575The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13576These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13577the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13578is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13579in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13580
13581@table @code
3d757584
SC
13582@item info win
13583@kindex info win
13584List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13585
8e04817f
AC
13586@item layout next
13587@kindex layout next
13588Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13589
8e04817f
AC
13590@item layout prev
13591@kindex layout prev
13592Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13593
8e04817f
AC
13594@item layout src
13595@kindex layout src
13596Display the source window only.
c906108c 13597
8e04817f
AC
13598@item layout asm
13599@kindex layout asm
13600Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13601
8e04817f
AC
13602@item layout split
13603@kindex layout split
13604Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13605
8e04817f
AC
13606@item layout regs
13607@kindex layout regs
13608Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13609
13610@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13611@kindex focus
13612Set the focus to the named window.
13613This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13614can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13615
8e04817f
AC
13616@item refresh
13617@kindex refresh
13618Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13619
8e04817f
AC
13620@item update
13621@kindex update
13622Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13623
8e04817f
AC
13624@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13625@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13626@kindex winheight
13627Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13628lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13629decrease it.
2df3850c 13630
c906108c
SS
13631@end table
13632
8e04817f
AC
13633@node TUI Configuration
13634@section TUI configuration variables
13635@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13636
8e04817f
AC
13637The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13638appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13639
8e04817f
AC
13640@table @code
13641@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13642@kindex set tui border-kind
13643Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13644The possible values are the following:
13645@table @code
13646@item space
13647Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13648
8e04817f
AC
13649@item ascii
13650Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13651
8e04817f
AC
13652@item acs
13653Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13654drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13655
8e04817f 13656@end table
c78b4128 13657
8e04817f
AC
13658@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13659@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13660Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13661The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13662@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13663
8e04817f
AC
13664@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13665@kindex set tui border-mode
13666Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13667The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13668@table @code
13669@item normal
13670Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13671
8e04817f
AC
13672@item standout
13673Use standout mode.
c906108c 13674
8e04817f
AC
13675@item reverse
13676Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13677
8e04817f
AC
13678@item half
13679Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13680
8e04817f
AC
13681@item half-standout
13682Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13683
8e04817f
AC
13684@item bold
13685Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13686
8e04817f
AC
13687@item bold-standout
13688Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13689
8e04817f 13690@end table
c78b4128 13691
8e04817f 13692@end table
c78b4128 13693
8e04817f
AC
13694@node Emacs
13695@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13696
8e04817f
AC
13697@cindex Emacs
13698@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13699A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13700edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13701@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13702
8e04817f
AC
13703To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13704executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13705@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13706created Emacs buffer.
13707@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13708
8e04817f
AC
13709Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13710things:
c906108c 13711
8e04817f
AC
13712@itemize @bullet
13713@item
13714All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13715@end itemize
c906108c 13716
8e04817f
AC
13717This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13718and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13719
8e04817f
AC
13720This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13721commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13722in this way.
bf0184be 13723
8e04817f
AC
13724All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13725with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13726way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13727stop.
bf0184be 13728
8e04817f 13729@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13730@item
8e04817f
AC
13731@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13732@end itemize
bf0184be 13733
8e04817f
AC
13734Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13735source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13736left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13737source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13738and the source.
bf0184be 13739
8e04817f
AC
13740Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13741usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13742
8e04817f
AC
13743@quotation
13744@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13745current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13746the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13747appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13748environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13749session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13750back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13751avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13752your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13753@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13754
8e04817f
AC
13755A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13756switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13757@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13758@end quotation
13759
13760By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13761you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13762several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13763Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13764
474c8240 13765@smallexample
8e04817f 13766(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13767@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13768
13769@noindent
13770(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13771in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13772``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13773
13774In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13775addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13776
8e04817f
AC
13777@table @kbd
13778@item C-h m
13779Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13780
8e04817f
AC
13781@item M-s
13782Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13783update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13784
8e04817f
AC
13785@item M-n
13786Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13787calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13788to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13789
8e04817f
AC
13790@item M-i
13791Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13792display window accordingly.
c906108c 13793
8e04817f
AC
13794@item M-x gdb-nexti
13795Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13796display window accordingly.
c906108c 13797
8e04817f
AC
13798@item C-c C-f
13799Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13800@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13801
8e04817f
AC
13802@item M-c
13803Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13804command.
b433d00b 13805
8e04817f 13806@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13807
8e04817f
AC
13808@item M-u
13809Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13810(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13811like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13812
8e04817f 13813@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13814
8e04817f
AC
13815@item M-d
13816Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13817@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13818
8e04817f 13819@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13820
8e04817f
AC
13821@item C-x &
13822Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13823of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13824around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13825then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13826argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13827
8e04817f
AC
13828You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13829@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13830otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13831inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13832wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13833list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13834formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13835is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13836@end table
c906108c 13837
8e04817f
AC
13838In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13839tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13840
8e04817f
AC
13841If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13842it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13843request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13844the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13845frame.
c906108c 13846
8e04817f
AC
13847The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13848which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13849the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13850communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13851delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13852to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13853
8e04817f
AC
13854@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13855@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13856@ignore
13857@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13858@kindex Epoch
13859@kindex inspect
c906108c 13860
8e04817f
AC
13861Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13862called the @code{epoch}
13863environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13864@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13865each value is printed in its own window.
13866@end ignore
c906108c 13867
8e04817f
AC
13868@include annotate.texi
13869@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13870
8e04817f
AC
13871@node GDB Bugs
13872@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13873@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13874@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13875
8e04817f 13876Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13877
8e04817f
AC
13878Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13879may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13880the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13881reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13882
8e04817f
AC
13883In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13884information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13885
13886@menu
8e04817f
AC
13887* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13888* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13889@end menu
13890
8e04817f
AC
13891@node Bug Criteria
13892@section Have you found a bug?
13893@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13894
8e04817f 13895If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13896
13897@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13898@cindex fatal signal
13899@cindex debugger crash
13900@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13901@item
8e04817f
AC
13902If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13903@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13904
13905@cindex error on valid input
13906@item
13907If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13908bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13909somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13910
8e04817f 13911@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13912@item
8e04817f
AC
13913If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13914that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13915``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13916for traditional practice''.
13917
13918@item
13919If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13920for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13921@end itemize
13922
8e04817f
AC
13923@node Bug Reporting
13924@section How to report bugs
13925@cindex bug reports
13926@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13927
13928A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13929If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13930contact that organization first.
13931
13932You can find contact information for many support companies and
13933individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13934distribution.
13935@c should add a web page ref...
13936
129188f6
AC
13937In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13938@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13939@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13940page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13941be used.
8e04817f
AC
13942
13943@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13944@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13945not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13946@samp{bug-gdb}.
13947
13948The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13949serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13950the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13951newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13952problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13953path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13954we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13955bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13956
8e04817f
AC
13957The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13958@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13959fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13960
8e04817f
AC
13961Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13962problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13963assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13964Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13965stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13966name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13967of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13968the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13969easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13970
8e04817f
AC
13971Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13972bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13973you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13974self-contained.
c4555f82 13975
8e04817f
AC
13976Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13977bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13978@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13979bugs properly.
13980
13981To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13982
13983@itemize @bullet
13984@item
8e04817f
AC
13985The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13986with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13987version}.
c4555f82 13988
8e04817f
AC
13989Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13990the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13991
13992@item
8e04817f
AC
13993The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13994version number.
c4555f82
SC
13995
13996@item
8e04817f
AC
13997What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13998``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13999
14000@item
8e04817f
AC
14001What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
14002debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
14003C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
14004information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
14005compilers.
c4555f82 14006
8e04817f
AC
14007@item
14008The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
14009observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
14010you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
14011Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 14012
8e04817f
AC
14013If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
14014and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 14015
8e04817f
AC
14016@item
14017A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
14018reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 14019
8e04817f
AC
14020@item
14021A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
14022incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 14023
8e04817f
AC
14024Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
14025will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
14026not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
14027a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 14028
8e04817f
AC
14029Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
14030say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
14031copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
14032the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
14033crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
14034ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
14035us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
14036to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 14037
8e04817f
AC
14038@item
14039If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
14040diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
14041it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 14042
8e04817f
AC
14043The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
14044sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 14045
8e04817f 14046@end itemize
c4555f82 14047
8e04817f 14048Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 14049
8e04817f
AC
14050@itemize @bullet
14051@item
14052A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 14053
8e04817f
AC
14054Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
14055which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
14056changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 14057
8e04817f
AC
14058This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
14059will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
14060with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
14061We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 14062
8e04817f
AC
14063Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
14064of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14065output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14066less time, and so on.
c4555f82 14067
8e04817f
AC
14068However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14069report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 14070
8e04817f
AC
14071@item
14072A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 14073
8e04817f
AC
14074A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14075the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14076a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14077to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 14078
8e04817f
AC
14079Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14080construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14081through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14082to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 14083
8e04817f
AC
14084And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14085patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14086help us to understand.
c4555f82 14087
8e04817f
AC
14088@item
14089A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 14090
8e04817f
AC
14091Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14092things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14093@end itemize
c4555f82 14094
8e04817f
AC
14095@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
14096@c and consists of the two following files:
14097@c rluser.texinfo
14098@c inc-hist.texinfo
14099@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14100@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14101@include rluser.texinfo
14102@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 14103
c4555f82 14104
8e04817f
AC
14105@node Formatting Documentation
14106@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 14107
8e04817f
AC
14108@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14109@cindex reference card
14110The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14111for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14112subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14113@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14114release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14115you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 14116
8e04817f
AC
14117The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14118can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 14119
474c8240 14120@smallexample
8e04817f 14121make refcard.dvi
474c8240 14122@end smallexample
c4555f82 14123
8e04817f
AC
14124The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14125mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14126that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14127high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14128your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 14129
8e04817f 14130@cindex documentation
c4555f82 14131
8e04817f
AC
14132All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14133distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14134a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14135on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14136formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14137and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 14138
8e04817f
AC
14139@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14140version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14141file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14142subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14143necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14144but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14145Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14146@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 14147
8e04817f
AC
14148If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14149Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14150@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 14151
8e04817f
AC
14152If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14153@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14154version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 14155
474c8240 14156@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14157cd gdb
14158make gdb.info
474c8240 14159@end smallexample
c4555f82 14160
8e04817f
AC
14161If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14162a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14163Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 14164
8e04817f
AC
14165@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14166produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14167document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14168has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14169command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14170(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14171require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 14172
8e04817f
AC
14173@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14174@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14175written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14176typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14177and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14178directory.
c4555f82 14179
8e04817f
AC
14180If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14181typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14182subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14183@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14184
474c8240 14185@smallexample
8e04817f 14186make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14187@end smallexample
c4555f82 14188
8e04817f 14189Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14190
8e04817f
AC
14191@node Installing GDB
14192@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14193@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14194@cindex installation
94e91d6d 14195@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
c4555f82 14196
8e04817f
AC
14197@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14198of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14199build the @code{gdb} program.
14200@iftex
14201@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14202@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14203look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14204installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14205@end iftex
c4555f82 14206
8e04817f
AC
14207The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14208@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14209appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14210
8e04817f
AC
14211For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14212@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14213
8e04817f
AC
14214@table @code
14215@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14216script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14217
8e04817f
AC
14218@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14219the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14220
8e04817f
AC
14221@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14222source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14223
8e04817f
AC
14224@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14225@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14226
8e04817f
AC
14227@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14228source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14229
8e04817f
AC
14230@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14231source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14232
8e04817f
AC
14233@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14234source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14235
8e04817f
AC
14236@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14237source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14238
8e04817f
AC
14239@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14240source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14241@end table
c906108c 14242
8e04817f
AC
14243The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14244from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14245this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14246
8e04817f
AC
14247First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14248if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14249identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14250argument.
c906108c 14251
8e04817f 14252For example:
c906108c 14253
474c8240 14254@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14255cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14256./configure @var{host}
14257make
474c8240 14258@end smallexample
c906108c 14259
8e04817f
AC
14260@noindent
14261where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14262@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14263(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14264correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14265
8e04817f
AC
14266Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14267@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14268libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14269binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14270
8e04817f
AC
14271@need 750
14272@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14273system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14274shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14275
474c8240 14276@smallexample
8e04817f 14277sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14278@end smallexample
c906108c 14279
8e04817f
AC
14280If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14281directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14282@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14283creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14284you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14285
94e91d6d
MC
14286You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
14287source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
14288@code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
14289that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
14290if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
14291of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
14292configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
14293directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
14294about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
c906108c 14295
8e04817f
AC
14296You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14297However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14298the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14299that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14300let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14301
8e04817f
AC
14302@menu
14303* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14304* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14305* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14306@end menu
c906108c 14307
8e04817f
AC
14308@node Separate Objdir
14309@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14310
8e04817f
AC
14311If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14312you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14313host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14314allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14315rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14316handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14317@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14318program specified there.
c906108c 14319
8e04817f
AC
14320To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14321with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14322(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14323itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14324would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14325the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14326
8e04817f
AC
14327For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14328separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14329
474c8240 14330@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14331@group
14332cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14333mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14334cd ../gdb-sun4
14335../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14336make
14337@end group
474c8240 14338@end smallexample
c906108c 14339
8e04817f
AC
14340When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14341directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14342(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14343the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14344directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14345@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14346
94e91d6d
MC
14347Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
14348instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
14349like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
14350one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
14351build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
14352
8e04817f
AC
14353One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14354directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14355@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14356programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14357You specify a cross-debugging target by
14358giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14359
8e04817f
AC
14360When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14361it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14362called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14363
8e04817f
AC
14364The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14365directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14366directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14367directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14368will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14369
8e04817f
AC
14370When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14371directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14372if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14373with each other.
c906108c 14374
8e04817f
AC
14375@node Config Names
14376@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14377
8e04817f
AC
14378The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14379script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14380aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14381of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14382
474c8240 14383@smallexample
8e04817f 14384@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14385@end smallexample
c906108c 14386
8e04817f
AC
14387For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14388or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14389option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14390
8e04817f
AC
14391The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14392any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14393aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14394@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14395script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14396abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14397
8e04817f
AC
14398@smallexample
14399% sh config.sub i386-linux
14400i386-pc-linux-gnu
14401% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14402alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14403% sh config.sub hp9k700
14404hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14405% sh config.sub sun4
14406sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14407% sh config.sub sun3
14408m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14409% sh config.sub i986v
14410Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14411@end smallexample
c906108c 14412
8e04817f
AC
14413@noindent
14414@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14415directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14416
8e04817f
AC
14417@node Configure Options
14418@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14419
8e04817f
AC
14420Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14421are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14422several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14423Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14424
474c8240 14425@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14426configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14427 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14428 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14429 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14430 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14431 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14432 @var{host}
474c8240 14433@end smallexample
c906108c 14434
8e04817f
AC
14435@noindent
14436You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14437@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14438@samp{--}.
c906108c 14439
8e04817f
AC
14440@table @code
14441@item --help
14442Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14443
8e04817f
AC
14444@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14445Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14446@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14447
8e04817f
AC
14448@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14449Configure the source to install programs under directory
14450@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14451
8e04817f
AC
14452@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14453@need 2000
14454@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14455@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14456@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14457Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14458@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14459build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14460directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14461the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14462directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14463the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14464@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14465
8e04817f
AC
14466@item --norecursion
14467Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14468propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14469
8e04817f
AC
14470@item --target=@var{target}
14471Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14472@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14473programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14474
8e04817f 14475There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14476
8e04817f
AC
14477@item @var{host} @dots{}
14478Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14479
8e04817f
AC
14480There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14481@end table
c906108c 14482
8e04817f
AC
14483There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14484needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14485
8e04817f
AC
14486@node Maintenance Commands
14487@appendix Maintenance Commands
14488@cindex maintenance commands
14489@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14490
8e04817f
AC
14491In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14492includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14493These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14494
8e04817f
AC
14495@table @code
14496@kindex maint info breakpoints
14497@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14498Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14499breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14500internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14501breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14502is shown:
c906108c 14503
8e04817f
AC
14504@table @code
14505@item breakpoint
14506Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14507
8e04817f
AC
14508@item watchpoint
14509Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14510
8e04817f
AC
14511@item longjmp
14512Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14513@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14514
8e04817f
AC
14515@item longjmp resume
14516Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14517
8e04817f
AC
14518@item until
14519Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14520
8e04817f
AC
14521@item finish
14522Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14523
8e04817f
AC
14524@item shlib events
14525Shared library events.
c906108c 14526
8e04817f 14527@end table
c906108c 14528
8d30a00d
AC
14529@kindex maint internal-error
14530@kindex maint internal-warning
14531@item maint internal-error
14532@itemx maint internal-warning
14533Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14534or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14535or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14536internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14537either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14538@value{GDBN} session.
14539
14540@smallexample
14541(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14542@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14543A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14544debugging may prove unreliable.
14545Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14546Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14547(gdb)
14548@end smallexample
14549
14550Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14551warning message.
14552
0680b120
AC
14553@kindex maint print registers
14554@kindex maint print raw-registers
14555@kindex maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 14556@kindex maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
14557@item maint print registers
14558@itemx maint print raw-registers
14559@itemx maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 14560@itemx maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
14561Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14562
617073a9
AC
14563The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14564the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
14565includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
14566@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
14567register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
14568@value{GDBN} Internals}.
0680b120
AC
14569
14570Takes an optional file parameter.
14571
617073a9
AC
14572@kindex maint print reggroups
14573@item maint print reggroups
14574Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
14575
14576Takes an optional file parameter.
14577
14578@smallexample
14579(gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
14580 Group Type
14581 general user
14582 float user
14583 all user
14584 vector user
14585 system user
14586 save internal
14587 restore internal
14588@end smallexample
14589
e7ba9c65
DJ
14590@kindex maint set profile
14591@kindex maint show profile
14592@cindex profiling GDB
14593@item maint set profile
14594@itemx maint show profile
14595Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
14596
14597Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
14598command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
14599collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
14600exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
14601if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
14602(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
14603data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
14604
14605Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
14606compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
14607
8e04817f 14608@end table
c906108c 14609
c906108c 14610
e0ce93ac 14611@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14612@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14613
ee2d5c50
AC
14614@menu
14615* Overview::
14616* Packets::
14617* Stop Reply Packets::
14618* General Query Packets::
14619* Register Packet Format::
14620* Examples::
14621@end menu
14622
14623@node Overview
14624@section Overview
14625
8e04817f
AC
14626There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14627protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14628machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14629recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14630
d2c6833e 14631In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14632transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14633
8e04817f
AC
14634@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14635@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14636@cindex remote serial protocol
14637All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14638sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14639@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14640@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14641
474c8240 14642@smallexample
8e04817f 14643@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14644@end smallexample
8e04817f 14645@noindent
c906108c 14646
8e04817f
AC
14647@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14648@noindent
14649The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14650characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14651eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14652
8e04817f
AC
14653Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14654specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14655
474c8240 14656@smallexample
8e04817f 14657@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14658@end smallexample
c906108c 14659
8e04817f
AC
14660@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14661@noindent
14662That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14663has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14664since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14665
8e04817f
AC
14666@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14667When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14668response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14669the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14670retransmission):
c906108c 14671
474c8240 14672@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14673-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14674<- @code{+}
474c8240 14675@end smallexample
8e04817f 14676@noindent
53a5351d 14677
8e04817f
AC
14678The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14679debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14680the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14681when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14682
8e04817f
AC
14683@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14684exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14685exceptions).
c906108c 14686
8e04817f 14687Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14688@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14689@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14690@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14691
8e04817f
AC
14692Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14693@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14694would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14695
8e04817f
AC
14696Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14697means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14698which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14699@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14700where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14701characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14702value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14703
8e04817f
AC
14704Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14705loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14706character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14707
8e04817f 14708So:
474c8240 14709@smallexample
8e04817f 14710"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14711@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14712@noindent
14713means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14714
8e04817f
AC
14715The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14716error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14717
8e04817f
AC
14718For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14719(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14720protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14721on that response.
c906108c 14722
8e04817f
AC
14723A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14724@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14725optional.
c906108c 14726
ee2d5c50
AC
14727@node Packets
14728@section Packets
14729
14730The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14731@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14732
14733@table @r
14734
14735@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14736@cindex @code{!} packet
14737
8e04817f
AC
14738Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14739persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14740debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14741
14742Reply:
14743@table @samp
14744@item OK
8e04817f 14745The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14746@end table
c906108c 14747
ee2d5c50
AC
14748@item @code{?} --- last signal
14749@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14750
ee2d5c50
AC
14751Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14752step and continue.
c906108c 14753
ee2d5c50
AC
14754Reply:
14755@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14756
14757@item @code{a} --- reserved
14758
14759Reserved for future use.
14760
14761@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14762@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14763
8e04817f
AC
14764Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14765specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14766See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14767
14768Reply:
14769@table @samp
14770@item OK
14771@item E@var{NN}
14772@end table
14773
14774@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14775@cindex @code{b} packet
14776
14777Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14778
14779JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14780received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14781problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14782
14783Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14784it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14785some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14786switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14787of view, nothing actually happened.}
14788
14789@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14790@cindex @code{B} packet
14791
8e04817f 14792Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14793breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14794
14795This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14796(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14797
ee2d5c50
AC
14798@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14799@cindex @code{c} packet
14800
14801@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14802current address.
c906108c 14803
ee2d5c50
AC
14804Reply:
14805@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14806
14807@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14808@cindex @code{C} packet
14809
8e04817f
AC
14810Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14811@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14812
ee2d5c50
AC
14813Reply:
14814@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14815
ee2d5c50
AC
14816@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14817@cindex @code{d} packet
14818
14819Toggle debug flag.
14820
14821@item @code{D} --- detach
14822@cindex @code{D} packet
14823
14824Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14825before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14826
14827Reply:
14828@table @samp
14829@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14830@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14831@end table
c906108c 14832
ee2d5c50 14833@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14834
ee2d5c50 14835Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14836
ee2d5c50 14837@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14838
ee2d5c50 14839Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14840
ee2d5c50
AC
14841@item @code{f} --- reserved
14842
14843Reserved for future use.
14844
14845@item @code{F} --- reserved
14846
14847Reserved for future use.
14848
14849@item @code{g} --- read registers
14850@anchor{read registers packet}
14851@cindex @code{g} packet
14852
14853Read general registers.
14854
14855Reply:
14856@table @samp
14857@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14858Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14859with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14860each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14861determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14862and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14863@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14864@item E@var{NN}
14865for an error.
14866@end table
c906108c 14867
ee2d5c50
AC
14868@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14869@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14870
ee2d5c50
AC
14871@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14872data.
14873
14874Reply:
14875@table @samp
14876@item OK
14877for success
14878@item E@var{NN}
14879for an error
14880@end table
14881
14882@item @code{h} --- reserved
14883
14884Reserved for future use.
14885
14886@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14887@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14888
8e04817f 14889Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14890@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14891should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14892operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14893the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14894
14895Reply:
14896@table @samp
14897@item OK
14898for success
14899@item E@var{NN}
14900for an error
14901@end table
c906108c 14902
8e04817f
AC
14903@c FIXME: JTC:
14904@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14905@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14906@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14907@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14908@c described. For example:
14909@c
14910@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14911@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14912@c otherwise returns current registers.
14913@c
14914@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14915@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14916@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14917
ee2d5c50
AC
14918@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14919@anchor{cycle step packet}
14920@cindex @code{i} packet
14921
8e04817f
AC
14922Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14923present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14924step starting at that address.
c906108c 14925
ee2d5c50
AC
14926@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14927@cindex @code{I} packet
14928
14929@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14930
14931@item @code{j} --- reserved
14932
14933Reserved for future use.
14934
14935@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14936
ee2d5c50 14937Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14938
ee2d5c50
AC
14939@item @code{k} --- kill request
14940@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14941
ac282366 14942FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14943thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14944thread?)}.
c906108c 14945
ee2d5c50 14946@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14947
ee2d5c50
AC
14948Reserved for future use.
14949
14950@item @code{l} --- reserved
14951
14952Reserved for future use.
14953
14954@item @code{L} --- reserved
14955
14956Reserved for future use.
14957
14958@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14959@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14960
8e04817f 14961Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14962Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14963assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14964transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14965
ee2d5c50
AC
14966Reply:
14967@table @samp
14968@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14969@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14970to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14971that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14972accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14973needed.}
14974@item E@var{NN}
14975@var{NN} is errno
14976@end table
14977
14978@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14979@cindex @code{M} packet
14980
8e04817f 14981Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14982@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14983
14984Reply:
14985@table @samp
14986@item OK
14987for success
14988@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14989for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14990written).
ee2d5c50 14991@end table
c906108c 14992
ee2d5c50 14993@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14994
ee2d5c50 14995Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14996
ee2d5c50 14997@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14998
ee2d5c50 14999Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15000
ee2d5c50
AC
15001@item @code{o} --- reserved
15002
15003Reserved for future use.
15004
15005@item @code{O} --- reserved
15006
15007Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15008
ee2d5c50
AC
15009@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
15010@cindex @code{p} packet
15011
15012@xref{write register packet}.
15013
15014Reply:
15015@table @samp
15016@item @var{r@dots{}.}
15017The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
15018@end table
15019
15020@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
15021@anchor{write register packet}
15022@cindex @code{P} packet
15023
15024Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 15025digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 15026
ee2d5c50
AC
15027Reply:
15028@table @samp
15029@item OK
15030for success
15031@item E@var{NN}
15032for an error
15033@end table
15034
15035@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
15036@anchor{general query packet}
15037@cindex @code{q} packet
15038
15039Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
15040leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
15041prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
15042be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
15043that they match the full @var{query} name.
15044
15045Reply:
15046@table @samp
15047@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15048Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
15049@item E@var{NN}
15050error reply
8e04817f 15051@item
ee2d5c50
AC
15052Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
15053@end table
15054
15055@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
15056@cindex @code{Q} packet
15057
15058Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
15059
15060@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 15061
ee2d5c50
AC
15062@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
15063@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 15064
8e04817f 15065Reset the entire system.
c906108c 15066
ee2d5c50
AC
15067@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
15068@cindex @code{R} packet
15069
8e04817f
AC
15070Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
15071This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
15072
15073Reply:
15074@table @samp
15075@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 15076The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
15077@end table
15078
15079@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
15080@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 15081
8e04817f
AC
15082@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
15083same address.
c906108c 15084
ee2d5c50
AC
15085Reply:
15086@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15087
15088@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
15089@anchor{step with signal packet}
15090@cindex @code{S} packet
15091
8e04817f 15092Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 15093
ee2d5c50
AC
15094Reply:
15095@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15096
15097@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
15098@cindex @code{t} packet
15099
8e04817f 15100Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
15101@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
15102@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 15103
ee2d5c50
AC
15104@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
15105@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 15106
ee2d5c50 15107Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 15108
ee2d5c50
AC
15109Reply:
15110@table @samp
15111@item OK
15112thread is still alive
15113@item E@var{NN}
15114thread is dead
15115@end table
15116
15117@item @code{u} --- reserved
15118
15119Reserved for future use.
15120
15121@item @code{U} --- reserved
15122
15123Reserved for future use.
15124
15125@item @code{v} --- reserved
15126
15127Reserved for future use.
15128
15129@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 15130
ee2d5c50 15131Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15132
ee2d5c50 15133@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 15134
ee2d5c50 15135Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15136
ee2d5c50 15137@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 15138
ee2d5c50 15139Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15140
ee2d5c50
AC
15141@item @code{x} --- reserved
15142
15143Reserved for future use.
15144
15145@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
15146@cindex @code{X} packet
15147
15148@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
15149is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 15150escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 15151
ee2d5c50
AC
15152Reply:
15153@table @samp
15154@item OK
15155for success
15156@item E@var{NN}
15157for an error
15158@end table
15159
15160@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 15161
ee2d5c50 15162Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15163
ee2d5c50
AC
15164@item @code{Y} reserved
15165
15166Reserved for future use.
15167
2f870471
AC
15168@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15169@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15170@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 15171@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 15172@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 15173
2f870471
AC
15174Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15175watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15176@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 15177
2f870471
AC
15178Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15179separately.
15180
512217c7
AC
15181@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
15182for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
15183remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
15184@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15185avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15186be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15187
15188@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15189@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15190@cindex @code{z0} packet
15191@cindex @code{Z0} packet
15192
15193Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15194@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15195
15196A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15197@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15198@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15199breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15200@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 15201
2f870471
AC
15202@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15203code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15204overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15205target, is not defined.}
c906108c 15206
ee2d5c50
AC
15207Reply:
15208@table @samp
2f870471
AC
15209@item OK
15210success
15211@item
15212not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
15213@item E@var{NN}
15214for an error
2f870471
AC
15215@end table
15216
15217@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15218@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15219@cindex @code{z1} packet
15220@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15221
15222Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15223address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15224
15225A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15226dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15227
15228@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15229movement.}
15230
15231Reply:
15232@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15233@item OK
2f870471
AC
15234success
15235@item
15236not supported
15237@item E@var{NN}
15238for an error
15239@end table
15240
15241@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15242@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15243@cindex @code{z2} packet
15244@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15245
15246Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15247
15248Reply:
15249@table @samp
15250@item OK
15251success
15252@item
15253not supported
15254@item E@var{NN}
15255for an error
15256@end table
15257
15258@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15259@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15260@cindex @code{z3} packet
15261@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15262
2e834e49 15263Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
15264
15265Reply:
15266@table @samp
15267@item OK
15268success
15269@item
15270not supported
15271@item E@var{NN}
15272for an error
15273@end table
15274
2e834e49
HPN
15275@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15276@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15277@cindex @code{z4} packet
15278@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15279
15280Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15281
15282Reply:
15283@table @samp
15284@item OK
15285success
15286@item
15287not supported
15288@item E@var{NN}
15289for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15290@end table
15291
15292@end table
c906108c 15293
ee2d5c50
AC
15294@node Stop Reply Packets
15295@section Stop Reply Packets
15296@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15297
8e04817f
AC
15298The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15299receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15300@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15301when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15302number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15303conventions is used.
c906108c 15304
ee2d5c50 15305@table @samp
c906108c 15306
ee2d5c50
AC
15307@item S@var{AA}
15308@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15309
8e04817f 15310@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15311@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15312
8e04817f
AC
15313@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15314(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15315by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15316thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15317@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15318integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15319@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15320to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15321
ee2d5c50
AC
15322@item W@var{AA}
15323
8e04817f 15324The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15325applicable to certain targets.
15326
15327@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15328
8e04817f 15329The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15330
ee2d5c50
AC
15331@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15332
15333@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15334@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15335base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15336The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15337the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15338is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15339
ee2d5c50 15340@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15341
ee2d5c50
AC
15342@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15343any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15344to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15345
15346@end table
15347
15348@node General Query Packets
15349@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15350
8e04817f 15351The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15352
ee2d5c50 15353@table @r
c906108c 15354
ee2d5c50
AC
15355@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15356
15357Return the current thread id.
15358
15359Reply:
15360@table @samp
15361@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15362Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15363@item *
15364Any other reply implies the old pid.
15365@end table
15366
15367@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15368
15369@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15370
8e04817f
AC
15371Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15372may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15373works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15374obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15375be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15376sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15377
15378NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15379
15380Reply:
15381@table @samp
15382@item @code{m}@var{id}
15383A single thread id
15384@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15385a comma-separated list of thread ids
15386@item @code{l}
15387(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15388@end table
15389
15390In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15391more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15392will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15393@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15394(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15395
ee2d5c50
AC
15396@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15397
15398Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15399string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15400string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15401@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15402in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15403possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15404Mutex''.
15405
15406Reply:
15407@table @samp
15408@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15409Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15410the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15411attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15412@end table
15413
15414@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15415
8e04817f
AC
15416Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15417digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15418subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15419number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15420(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15421returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15422
15423NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15424(see above).
15425
15426Reply:
15427@table @samp
15428@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15429Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15430returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15431and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15432digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15433is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15434digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15435@end table
c906108c 15436
ee2d5c50
AC
15437@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15438
15439Reply:
15440@table @samp
15441@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15442An error (such as memory fault)
15443@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15444A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15445@end table
15446
15447@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15448
8e04817f
AC
15449Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15450image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15451response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15452offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15453
ee2d5c50
AC
15454Reply:
15455@table @samp
15456@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15457@end table
15458
15459@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15460
8e04817f
AC
15461Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15462encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15463
15464Reply:
15465@table @samp
15466@item *
15467@end table
15468
8e04817f 15469See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15470
ee2d5c50
AC
15471@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15472
15473@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15474execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15475Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15476number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15477@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15478interpreter may have security implications}.
15479
15480Reply:
15481@table @samp
15482@item OK
8e04817f 15483A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15484@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15485A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15486@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15487Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15488@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15489When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15490@end table
15491
15492@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15493
8e04817f
AC
15494Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15495requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15496
15497Reply:
15498@table @samp
15499@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15500The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15501@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15502The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15503@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15504@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15505@end table
15506
15507@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15508
15509Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15510
15511@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15512target has previously requested.
15513
15514@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15515@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15516will be empty.
15517
15518Reply:
15519@table @samp
15520@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15521The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15522@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15523The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15524encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15525(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15526@end table
eb12ee30 15527
ee2d5c50
AC
15528@end table
15529
15530@node Register Packet Format
15531@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15532
8e04817f 15533The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15534In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15535sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15536to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15537byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15538most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15539
ee2d5c50 15540@table @r
eb12ee30 15541
8e04817f 15542@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15543
8e04817f
AC
15544All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1554532 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15546registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15547
8e04817f 15548@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15549
8e04817f
AC
15550All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15551thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15552as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15553
ee2d5c50
AC
15554@end table
15555
15556@node Examples
15557@section Examples
eb12ee30 15558
8e04817f
AC
15559Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15560does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15561
474c8240 15562@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15563-> @code{R00}
15564<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15565@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15566-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15567<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15568<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15569-> @code{+}
474c8240 15570@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15571
8e04817f 15572Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15573
474c8240 15574@smallexample
d2c6833e 15575-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15576<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15577-> @code{s}
15578<- @code{+}
15579@emph{time passes}
15580<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15581-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15582-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15583<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15584<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15585-> @code{+}
474c8240 15586@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15587
aab4e0ec 15588@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15589
6826cf00
EZ
15590@include fdl.texi
15591
6d2ebf8b 15592@node Index
c906108c
SS
15593@unnumbered Index
15594
15595@printindex cp
15596
15597@tex
15598% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15599% meantime:
15600\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15601\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15602\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15603\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15604\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15605\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15606\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15607\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15608\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15609\page\colophon
15610% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15611@end tex
15612
c906108c 15613@bye
This page took 1.422882 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.